]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - src/xterm.c
Merge from emacs-24; up to 2012-12-06T01:39:03Z!monnier@iro.umontreal.ca
[gnu-emacs] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
22
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <stdio.h>
25
26 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
27
28 #include "lisp.h"
29 #include "blockinput.h"
30 #include "syssignal.h"
31
32 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
33 if this is not done before the other system files. */
34 #include "xterm.h"
35 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
36
37 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
38 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
39 #ifndef makedev
40 #include <sys/types.h>
41 #endif /* makedev */
42
43 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
44
45 #include "systime.h"
46
47 #include <fcntl.h>
48 #include <errno.h>
49 #include <sys/stat.h>
50 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
51 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
52
53 #include "charset.h"
54 #include "character.h"
55 #include "coding.h"
56 #include "frame.h"
57 #include "dispextern.h"
58 #include "fontset.h"
59 #include "termhooks.h"
60 #include "termopts.h"
61 #include "termchar.h"
62 #include "emacs-icon.h"
63 #include "disptab.h"
64 #include "buffer.h"
65 #include "window.h"
66 #include "keyboard.h"
67 #include "intervals.h"
68 #include "process.h"
69 #include "atimer.h"
70 #include "keymap.h"
71 #include "font.h"
72 #include "fontset.h"
73 #include "xsettings.h"
74 #include "xgselect.h"
75 #include "sysselect.h"
76
77 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
78 #include <X11/Shell.h>
79 #endif
80
81 #include <unistd.h>
82
83 #ifdef USE_GTK
84 #include "gtkutil.h"
85 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
86 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
87 #endif
88 #endif
89
90 #ifdef USE_LUCID
91 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
92 #endif
93
94 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
95 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
96 #define HACK_EDITRES
97 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
98 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
99
100 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
101
102 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
103 #if defined USE_MOTIF
104 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
105 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
106 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
107
108 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
109 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
110 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
111 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
112 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
113 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
114 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
115 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
116 #ifndef XtNpickTop
117 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
118 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
119 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
120 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
121
122 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
123
124 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
125 #include "widget.h"
126 #ifndef XtNinitialState
127 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
128 #endif
129 #endif
130
131 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
132
133 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
134 #ifdef USE_XIM
135 int use_xim = 1;
136 #else
137 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
138 #endif
139
140 \f
141
142 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
143 start. */
144
145 static int any_help_event_p;
146
147 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
148 static Lisp_Object last_window;
149
150 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
151 use. */
152
153 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
154
155 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
156 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
157 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
158 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
159
160 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
161
162 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
163
164 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
165
166 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
167
168 static struct {
169 struct frame *f;
170 int eventtype;
171 } pending_event_wait;
172
173 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
174 /* The application context for Xt use. */
175 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
176 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
177
178 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
179
180 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
181 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
182
183 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
184 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
185 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
186
187 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
188
189 /* Mouse movement.
190
191 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
192 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
193 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
194 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
195
196 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
197
198 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
199 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
200 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
201 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
202 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
203 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
204 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
205 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
206 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
207 is off. */
208
209 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
210
211 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
212 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
213 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
214
215 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
216
217 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
218 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
219 an ordinary motion.
220
221 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
222 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
223 event. */
224
225 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
226
227 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
228 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
229 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
230 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
231 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
232 it's somewhat accurate. */
233
234 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
235
236 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
237
238 static Time last_user_time;
239
240 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
241 events. */
242
243 static int volatile input_signal_count;
244
245 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
246
247 static int x_noop_count;
248
249 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
250
251 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
252 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
253
254 #ifdef USE_GTK
255 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
256 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
257
258 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
259 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
260 #endif
261
262 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
263 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
264
265 enum xembed_info
266 {
267 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
268 };
269
270 enum xembed_message
271 {
272 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
273 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
274 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
275 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
276 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
277 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
278 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
279 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
280
281 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
282 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
283 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
284 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
285 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
286 };
287
288 /* Used in x_flush. */
289
290 static bool x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
291 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
292 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
293 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
294 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
295 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
296
297 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
298 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
299 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
300 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
301 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
302 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
303 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
304 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
305 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
306 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
307 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
308 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
309 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
310 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
311 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
312 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
313 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
314 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
315 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
316 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
317 enum text_cursor_kinds);
318
319 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
320 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
321 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
322 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
323 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
324 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
325 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
326 enum scroll_bar_part *,
327 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
328 Time *);
329 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
330 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
331 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
332 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
333 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
334 int *, struct input_event *);
335 #ifdef USE_GTK
336 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
337 #endif
338 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
339 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
340 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
341 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
342 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
343 static void x_initialize (void);
344
345
346 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
347
348 static void
349 x_flush (struct frame *f)
350 {
351 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
352 connection may be broken. */
353 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
354 return;
355
356 block_input ();
357 if (f == NULL)
358 {
359 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
360 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
361 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
362 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
363 }
364 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
365 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
366 unblock_input ();
367 }
368
369
370 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
371 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
372 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
373 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
374 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
375 performance. */
376
377 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
378
379 \f
380 /***********************************************************************
381 Debugging
382 ***********************************************************************/
383
384 #if 0
385
386 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
387 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
388
389 struct record
390 {
391 char *locus;
392 int type;
393 };
394
395 struct record event_record[100];
396
397 int event_record_index;
398
399 void
400 record_event (char *locus, int type)
401 {
402 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
403 event_record_index = 0;
404
405 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
406 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
407 event_record_index++;
408 }
409
410 #endif /* 0 */
411
412
413 \f
414 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
415
416 struct x_display_info *
417 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
418 {
419 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
420
421 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
422 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
423 return dpyinfo;
424
425 return 0;
426 }
427
428 static Window
429 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
430 {
431 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
432 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
433 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
434
435 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
436 {
437 Window root;
438 Window *children;
439 unsigned int nchildren;
440
441 win = wi;
442 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
443 XFree (children);
444 }
445
446 return win;
447 }
448
449 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
450
451 void
452 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
453 {
454 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
455 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
456 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
457 double alpha = 1.0;
458 double alpha_min = 1.0;
459 unsigned long opac;
460 Window parent;
461
462 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
463 alpha = f->alpha[0];
464 else
465 alpha = f->alpha[1];
466
467 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
468 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
469 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
470 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
471
472 if (alpha < 0.0)
473 return;
474 else if (alpha > 1.0)
475 alpha = 1.0;
476 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
477 alpha = alpha_min;
478
479 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
480
481 x_catch_errors (dpy);
482
483 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
484 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
485 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
486 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
487
488 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
489 if (parent != None)
490 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
491 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
492 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
493
494 /* return unless necessary */
495 {
496 unsigned char *data;
497 Atom actual;
498 int rc, format;
499 unsigned long n, left;
500
501 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
502 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
503 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
504 &data);
505
506 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
507 {
508 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
509 XFree (data);
510 if (value == opac)
511 {
512 x_uncatch_errors ();
513 return;
514 }
515 }
516 }
517
518 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
519 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
520 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
521 x_uncatch_errors ();
522 }
523
524 int
525 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
526 {
527 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
528 }
529
530 int
531 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
532 {
533 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
534 }
535
536 \f
537 /***********************************************************************
538 Starting and ending an update
539 ***********************************************************************/
540
541 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
542 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
543 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
544 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
545 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
546
547 static void
548 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
549 {
550 /* Nothing to do. */
551 }
552
553
554 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
555 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
556 position of W. */
557
558 static void
559 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
560 {
561 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
562 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
563
564 updated_window = w;
565 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
566
567 block_input ();
568
569 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
570 {
571 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
572 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
573
574 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
575 highlighting. */
576 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
577 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
578 }
579
580 unblock_input ();
581 }
582
583
584 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
585
586 static void
587 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
588 {
589 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
590 struct face *face;
591
592 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
593 if (face)
594 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
595 face->foreground);
596
597 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
598 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
599 }
600
601 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
602
603 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
604 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
605
606 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
607 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
608 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
609
610 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
611 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
612 here. */
613
614 static void
615 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
616 {
617 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
618
619 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
620 {
621 block_input ();
622
623 if (cursor_on_p)
624 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
625 output_cursor.vpos,
626 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
627
628 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
629 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
630
631 unblock_input ();
632 }
633
634 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
635 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
636 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
637 {
638 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
639 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
640 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
641 }
642
643 updated_window = NULL;
644 }
645
646
647 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
648 update_end. */
649
650 static void
651 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
652 {
653 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
654 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
655
656 #ifndef XFlush
657 block_input ();
658 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
659 unblock_input ();
660 #endif
661 }
662
663
664 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
665 complete update has been performed. The global variable
666 updated_window is not available here. */
667
668 static void
669 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
670 {
671 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
672 FRAME_MOUSE_UPDATE (f);
673 }
674
675
676 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
677 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
678 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
679 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
680 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
681 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
682
683 static void
684 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
685 {
686 struct window *w = updated_window;
687 struct frame *f;
688 int width, height;
689
690 eassert (w);
691
692 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
693 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
694
695 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
696 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
697 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
698 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
699 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
700 overhead is very small. */
701 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
702 && desired_row->full_width_p
703 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
704 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
705 width != 0)
706 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
707 height > 0))
708 {
709 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
710
711 block_input ();
712 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
713 0, y, width, height, False);
714 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
715 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
716 y, width, height, False);
717 unblock_input ();
718 }
719 }
720
721 static void
722 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
723 {
724 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
725 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
726 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
727 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
728 struct face *face = p->face;
729
730 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
731 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
732
733 if (!p->overlay_p)
734 {
735 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
736
737 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
738 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
739 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
740 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
741 if (face->stipple)
742 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
743 else
744 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
745
746 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
747 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
748 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
749 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
750 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
751 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
752 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
753 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
754 {
755 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
756
757 if (sb_width > 0)
758 {
759 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
760 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
761 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
762
763 if (bx < 0)
764 {
765 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
766 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
767 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
768 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
769 bx = bar_area_x;
770 if (bx >= 0)
771 {
772 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
773
774 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
775 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
776 row->y));
777 ny = row->visible_height;
778 }
779 }
780 else
781 {
782 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
783 {
784 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
785 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
786 }
787 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
788 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
789 }
790 }
791 }
792 #endif
793 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
794 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
795
796 if (!face->stipple)
797 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
798 }
799
800 if (p->which)
801 {
802 char *bits;
803 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
804 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
805 XGCValues gcv;
806
807 if (p->wd > 8)
808 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
809 else
810 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
811
812 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
813 by the server. */
814 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
815 (p->cursor_p
816 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
817 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
818 : face->foreground),
819 face->background, depth);
820
821 if (p->overlay_p)
822 {
823 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
824 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
825 bits, p->wd, p->h,
826 1, 0, 1);
827 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
828 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
829 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
830 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
831 }
832
833 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
834 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
835 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
836
837 if (p->overlay_p)
838 {
839 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
840 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
841 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
842 }
843 }
844
845 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
846 }
847
848 \f
849
850 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
851 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
852 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
853 rarely happens). */
854
855 static void
856 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
857 {
858 }
859
860 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
861 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
862
863 static void
864 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
865 {
866 }
867
868 \f
869 /***********************************************************************
870 Glyph display
871 ***********************************************************************/
872
873
874
875 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
876 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
877 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
878 int);
879 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
880 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
881 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
882 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
883 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
884 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
885 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
886 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
887 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
888 static bool x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
889 unsigned long *, double, int);
890 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
891 double, int, unsigned long);
892 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
893 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
894 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
895 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
896 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
897 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
898 int, int, int);
899 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
900 int, int, int, int, int, int,
901 XRectangle *);
902 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
903 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
904 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
905
906 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
907 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
908 #endif
909
910
911 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
912 face. */
913
914 static void
915 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
916 {
917 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
918 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
919 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
920 && !s->cmp)
921 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
922 else
923 {
924 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
925 XGCValues xgcv;
926 unsigned long mask;
927
928 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
929 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
930
931 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
932 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
933 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
934 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
935 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
936 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
937 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
938
939 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
940 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
941 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
942 {
943 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
944 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
945 }
946
947 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
948 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
949 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
950
951 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
952 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
953 mask, &xgcv);
954 else
955 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
956 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
957
958 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
959 }
960 }
961
962
963 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
964
965 static void
966 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
967 {
968 int face_id;
969 struct face *face;
970
971 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
972 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
973 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
974 if (face == NULL)
975 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
976
977 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
978 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
979 else
980 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
981 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
982 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
983
984 if (s->font == s->face->font)
985 s->gc = s->face->gc;
986 else
987 {
988 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
989 except for FONT. */
990 XGCValues xgcv;
991 unsigned long mask;
992
993 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
994 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
995 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
996 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
997
998 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
999 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1000 mask, &xgcv);
1001 else
1002 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1003 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1004
1005 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1006
1007 }
1008 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1009 }
1010
1011
1012 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1013 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1014 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1015
1016 static void
1017 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1018 {
1019 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1020 }
1021
1022
1023 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1024 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1025 pattern. */
1026
1027 static void
1028 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1029 {
1030 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1031
1032 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1033 {
1034 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1035 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1036 }
1037 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1038 {
1039 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1040 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1041 }
1042 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1043 {
1044 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1045 s->stippled_p = 0;
1046 }
1047 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1048 {
1049 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1050 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1051 }
1052 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1053 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1054 {
1055 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1056 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1057 }
1058 else
1059 {
1060 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1061 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1062 }
1063
1064 /* GC must have been set. */
1065 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1066 }
1067
1068
1069 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1070 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1071
1072 static void
1073 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1074 {
1075 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1076 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1077
1078 if (n > 0)
1079 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1080 s->num_clips = n;
1081 }
1082
1083
1084 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1085 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1086 the area of SRC. */
1087
1088 static void
1089 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1090 {
1091 XRectangle r;
1092
1093 r.x = src->x;
1094 r.width = src->width;
1095 r.y = src->y;
1096 r.height = src->height;
1097 dst->clip[0] = r;
1098 dst->num_clips = 1;
1099 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1100 }
1101
1102
1103 /* RIF:
1104 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1105
1106 static void
1107 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1108 {
1109 if (s->cmp == NULL
1110 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1111 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1112 {
1113 struct font_metrics metrics;
1114
1115 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1116 {
1117 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1118 struct font *font = s->font;
1119 int i;
1120
1121 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1122 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1123 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1124 }
1125 else
1126 {
1127 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1128
1129 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1130 }
1131 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1132 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1133 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1134 }
1135 else if (s->cmp)
1136 {
1137 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1138 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1139 }
1140 }
1141
1142
1143 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1144
1145 static void
1146 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1147 {
1148 XGCValues xgcv;
1149 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1150 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1151 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1152 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1153 }
1154
1155
1156 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1157 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1158 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1159 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1160 contains the first component of a composition. */
1161
1162 static void
1163 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1164 {
1165 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1166 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1167 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1168 {
1169 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1170
1171 if (s->stippled_p)
1172 {
1173 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1174 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1175 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1176 s->y + box_line_width,
1177 s->background_width,
1178 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1179 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1180 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1181 }
1182 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1183 || s->font_not_found_p
1184 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1185 || force_p)
1186 {
1187 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1188 s->background_width,
1189 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1190 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1191 }
1192 }
1193 }
1194
1195
1196 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1197
1198 static void
1199 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1200 {
1201 int i, x;
1202
1203 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1204 of S to the right of that box line. */
1205 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1206 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1207 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1208 else
1209 x = s->x;
1210
1211 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1212 loaded. */
1213 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1214 {
1215 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1216 {
1217 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1218 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1219 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1220 s->height - 1);
1221 x += g->pixel_width;
1222 }
1223 }
1224 else
1225 {
1226 struct font *font = s->font;
1227 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1228 int y;
1229
1230 if (font->vertical_centering)
1231 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1232
1233 y = s->ybase - boff;
1234 if (s->for_overlaps
1235 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1236 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1237 else
1238 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1239 if (s->face->overstrike)
1240 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1241 }
1242 }
1243
1244 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1245
1246 static void
1247 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1248 {
1249 int i, j, x;
1250 struct font *font = s->font;
1251
1252 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1253 of S to the right of that box line. */
1254 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1255 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1256 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1257 else
1258 x = s->x;
1259
1260 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1261 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1262 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1263 this composition. */
1264
1265 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1266 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1267 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1268 {
1269 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1270 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1271 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1272 }
1273 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1274 {
1275 int y = s->ybase;
1276
1277 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1278 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1279 space on the left or right. */
1280 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1281 {
1282 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1283 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1284
1285 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1286 if (s->face->overstrike)
1287 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1288 }
1289 }
1290 else
1291 {
1292 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1293 Lisp_Object glyph;
1294 int y = s->ybase;
1295 int width = 0;
1296
1297 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1298 {
1299 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1300 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1301 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1302 else
1303 {
1304 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1305
1306 if (j < i)
1307 {
1308 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1309 if (s->face->overstrike)
1310 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1311 x += width;
1312 }
1313 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1314 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1315 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1316 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1317 if (s->face->overstrike)
1318 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1319 x += wadjust;
1320 j = i + 1;
1321 width = 0;
1322 }
1323 }
1324 if (j < i)
1325 {
1326 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1327 if (s->face->overstrike)
1328 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1329 }
1330 }
1331 }
1332
1333
1334 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1335
1336 static void
1337 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1338 {
1339 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1340 XChar2b char2b[8];
1341 int x, i, j;
1342
1343 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1344 of S to the right of that box line. */
1345 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1346 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1347 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1348 else
1349 x = s->x;
1350
1351 s->char2b = char2b;
1352
1353 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1354 {
1355 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1356 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1357
1358 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1359 {
1360 if (len > 0
1361 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1362 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1363 >= 1))
1364 {
1365 Lisp_Object acronym
1366 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1367 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1368 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1369 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1370 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1371 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1372 }
1373 }
1374 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1375 {
1376 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1377 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1378 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1379 str = buf;
1380 }
1381
1382 if (str)
1383 {
1384 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1385 unsigned code;
1386
1387 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1388 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1389 {
1390 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1391 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1392 }
1393 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1394 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1395 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1396 0);
1397 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1398 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1399 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1400 0);
1401 }
1402 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1403 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1404 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1405 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1406 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1407 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1408 }
1409 }
1410
1411 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1412
1413 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1414 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1415 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1416 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1417
1418 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1419
1420 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1421 cannot be determined. */
1422
1423 static struct frame *
1424 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1425 {
1426 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1427 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
1428 struct frame *f;
1429
1430 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1431
1432 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1433 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1434 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1435 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1436 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1437 widget = XtParent (widget);
1438
1439 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1440 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1441 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
1442 {
1443 f = XFRAME (frame);
1444 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
1445 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1446 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo
1447 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1448 return f;
1449 }
1450 emacs_abort ();
1451 }
1452
1453 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1454 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1455 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1456 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1457 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1458 Value is true if successful. */
1459
1460 bool
1461 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1462 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1463 {
1464 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1465 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1466 }
1467
1468 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1469
1470
1471 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1472 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1473
1474 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1475 {
1476 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1477 sizeof (Screen *)},
1478 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1479 sizeof (Colormap)}
1480 };
1481
1482
1483 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1484 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1485
1486 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1487
1488
1489 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1490
1491 DPY is the display we are working on.
1492
1493 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1494 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1495 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1496 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1497
1498 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1499 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1500
1501 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1502 we allocated the color or not.
1503
1504 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1505
1506 static Boolean
1507 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1508 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1509 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1510 {
1511 Screen *screen;
1512 Colormap cmap;
1513 Pixel pixel;
1514 String color_name;
1515 XColor color;
1516
1517 if (*nargs != 2)
1518 {
1519 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1520 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1521 "XtToolkitError",
1522 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1523 return False;
1524 }
1525
1526 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1527 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1528 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1529
1530 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1531 {
1532 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1533 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1534 }
1535 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1536 {
1537 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1538 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1539 }
1540 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1541 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1542 {
1543 pixel = color.pixel;
1544 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1545 }
1546 else
1547 {
1548 String params[1];
1549 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1550
1551 params[0] = color_name;
1552 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1553 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1554 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1555 params, &nparams);
1556 return False;
1557 }
1558
1559 if (to->addr != NULL)
1560 {
1561 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1562 {
1563 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1564 return False;
1565 }
1566
1567 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1568 }
1569 else
1570 {
1571 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1572 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1573 }
1574
1575 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1576 return True;
1577 }
1578
1579
1580 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1581 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1582 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1583
1584 APP is the application context in which we work.
1585
1586 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1587 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1588 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1589
1590 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1591
1592 static void
1593 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1594 Cardinal *nargs)
1595 {
1596 if (*nargs != 2)
1597 {
1598 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1599 "XtToolkitError",
1600 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1601 NULL, NULL);
1602 }
1603 else if (closure != NULL)
1604 {
1605 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1606 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1607 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1608 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1609 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1610 }
1611 }
1612
1613
1614 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1615
1616
1617 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1618 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1619 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1620 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1621
1622 static const XColor *
1623 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1624 {
1625 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1626
1627 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1628 {
1629 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1630 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1631 int i;
1632
1633 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1634 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1635 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1636
1637 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1638 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1639
1640 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1641 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1642 }
1643
1644 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1645 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1646 }
1647
1648
1649 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1650 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1651
1652 void
1653 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1654 {
1655 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1656
1657 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1658 {
1659 int i;
1660 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1661 {
1662 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1663 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1664 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1665 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1666 }
1667 }
1668 else
1669 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1670 }
1671
1672
1673 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1674 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1675
1676 void
1677 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1678 {
1679 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1680 }
1681
1682
1683 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1684 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1685 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1686 allocated. */
1687
1688 static bool
1689 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1690 {
1691 bool rc;
1692
1693 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1694 if (rc == 0)
1695 {
1696 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1697 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1698 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1699 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1700 int nearest, i;
1701 int max_color_delta = 255;
1702 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1703 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1704 int ncells;
1705 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1706
1707 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1708 {
1709 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1710 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1711 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1712 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1713
1714 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1715 {
1716 nearest = i;
1717 nearest_delta = delta;
1718 }
1719 }
1720
1721 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1722 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1723 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1724 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1725 }
1726 else
1727 {
1728 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1729 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1730 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1731 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1732 XColor *cached_color;
1733
1734 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1735 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1736 (cached_color->red != color->red
1737 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1738 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1739 {
1740 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1741 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1742 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1743 }
1744 }
1745
1746 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1747 if (rc)
1748 register_color (color->pixel);
1749 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1750
1751 return rc;
1752 }
1753
1754
1755 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1756 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1757 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1758 allocated. */
1759
1760 bool
1761 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1762 {
1763 gamma_correct (f, color);
1764 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1765 }
1766
1767
1768 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1769 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1770 get color reference counts right. */
1771
1772 unsigned long
1773 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1774 {
1775 XColor color;
1776
1777 color.pixel = pixel;
1778 block_input ();
1779 x_query_color (f, &color);
1780 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1781 unblock_input ();
1782 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1783 register_color (pixel);
1784 #endif
1785 return color.pixel;
1786 }
1787
1788
1789 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1790 boosted.
1791
1792 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1793 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1794 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1795 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1796 use an additional additive factor.
1797
1798 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1799 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1800 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1801
1802
1803 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1804 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1805 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1806 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1807 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1808 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1809
1810 static bool
1811 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1812 {
1813 XColor color, new;
1814 long bright;
1815 bool success_p;
1816
1817 /* Get RGB color values. */
1818 color.pixel = *pixel;
1819 x_query_color (f, &color);
1820
1821 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1822 eassert (factor >= 0);
1823 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1824 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1825 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1826
1827 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1828 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1829
1830 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1831 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1832 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1833 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1834 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1835 {
1836 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1837 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1838 /* The additive adjustment. */
1839 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1840
1841 if (factor < 1)
1842 {
1843 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1844 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1845 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1846 }
1847 else
1848 {
1849 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1850 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1851 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1852 }
1853 }
1854
1855 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1856 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1857 if (success_p)
1858 {
1859 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1860 {
1861 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1862 delta to the RGB values. */
1863 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1864
1865 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1866 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1867 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1868 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1869 }
1870 else
1871 success_p = 1;
1872 *pixel = new.pixel;
1873 }
1874
1875 return success_p;
1876 }
1877
1878
1879 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1880 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1881 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1882 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1883 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1884 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1885
1886 static void
1887 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1888 {
1889 XGCValues xgcv;
1890 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1891 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1892 unsigned long pixel;
1893 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1894 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1895 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1896 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1897
1898 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1899 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1900
1901 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1902 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1903 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1904 if (relief->gc
1905 && relief->allocated_p)
1906 {
1907 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1908 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1909 }
1910
1911 /* Allocate new color. */
1912 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1913 pixel = background;
1914 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1915 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1916 {
1917 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1918 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1919 }
1920
1921 if (relief->gc == 0)
1922 {
1923 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1924 mask |= GCStipple;
1925 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1926 }
1927 else
1928 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1929 }
1930
1931
1932 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1933
1934 static void
1935 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1936 {
1937 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1938 unsigned long color;
1939
1940 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1941 color = s->face->box_color;
1942 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1943 && s->img->pixmap
1944 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1945 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1946 else
1947 {
1948 XGCValues xgcv;
1949
1950 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1951 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1952 color = xgcv.background;
1953 }
1954
1955 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1956 || color != di->relief_background)
1957 {
1958 di->relief_background = color;
1959 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1960 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1961 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1962 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1963 }
1964 }
1965
1966
1967 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1968 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1969 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1970 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1971 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1972 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1973 when drawing. */
1974
1975 static void
1976 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1977 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1978 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1979 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1980 {
1981 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1982 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1983 int i;
1984 GC gc;
1985
1986 if (raised_p)
1987 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1988 else
1989 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1990 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1991
1992 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1993 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1994 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1995 corner pixels. */
1996
1997 /* Top. */
1998 if (top_p)
1999 {
2000 if (width == 1)
2001 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2002 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2003 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2004
2005 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2006 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2007 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2008 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2009 }
2010
2011 /* Left. */
2012 if (left_p)
2013 {
2014 if (width == 1)
2015 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2016
2017 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2018 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2019
2020 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2021 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2022 left_x + i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2023 left_x + i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2024 }
2025
2026 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2027 if (raised_p)
2028 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2029 else
2030 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2031 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2032
2033 if (width > 1)
2034 {
2035 /* Outermost top line. */
2036 if (top_p)
2037 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2038 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2039 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2040
2041 /* Outermost left line. */
2042 if (left_p)
2043 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2044 }
2045
2046 /* Bottom. */
2047 if (bot_p)
2048 {
2049 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2050 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2051 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2052 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2053 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2054 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2055 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2056 }
2057
2058 /* Right. */
2059 if (right_p)
2060 {
2061 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2062 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2063 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2064 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2065 right_x - i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2066 right_x - i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2067 }
2068
2069 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2070 }
2071
2072
2073 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2074 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2075 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2076 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2077 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2078 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2079
2080 static void
2081 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2082 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2083 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2084 {
2085 XGCValues xgcv;
2086
2087 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2088 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2089 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2090
2091 /* Top. */
2092 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2093 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2094
2095 /* Left. */
2096 if (left_p)
2097 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2098 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2099
2100 /* Bottom. */
2101 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2102 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2103
2104 /* Right. */
2105 if (right_p)
2106 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2107 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2108
2109 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2110 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2111 }
2112
2113
2114 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2115
2116 static void
2117 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2118 {
2119 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2120 int left_p, right_p;
2121 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2122 XRectangle clip_rect;
2123
2124 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2125 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2126 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2127
2128 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2129 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2130 ? s->first_glyph
2131 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2132
2133 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2134 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2135 left_x = s->x;
2136 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2137 ? last_x - 1
2138 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2139 top_y = s->y;
2140 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2141
2142 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2143 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2144 && (s->prev == NULL
2145 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2146 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2147 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2148 && (s->next == NULL
2149 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2150
2151 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2152
2153 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2154 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2155 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2156 else
2157 {
2158 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2159 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2160 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2161 }
2162 }
2163
2164
2165 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2166
2167 static void
2168 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2169 {
2170 int x = s->x;
2171 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2172
2173 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2174 right of that line. */
2175 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2176 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2177 && s->slice.x == 0)
2178 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2179
2180 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2181 by that margin. */
2182 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2183 x += s->img->hmargin;
2184 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2185 y += s->img->vmargin;
2186
2187 if (s->img->pixmap)
2188 {
2189 if (s->img->mask)
2190 {
2191 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2192 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2193 trust on the shape extension to be available
2194 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2195 manually. */
2196 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2197 | GCFunction);
2198 XGCValues xgcv;
2199 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2200
2201 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2202 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2203 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2204 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2205 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2206
2207 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2208 image_rect.x = x;
2209 image_rect.y = y;
2210 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2211 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2212 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2213 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2214 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2215 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2216 }
2217 else
2218 {
2219 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2220
2221 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2222 image_rect.x = x;
2223 image_rect.y = y;
2224 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2225 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2226 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2227 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2228 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2229 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2230
2231 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2232 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2233 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2234 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2235 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2236 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2237 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2238 {
2239 int relief = eabs (s->img->relief);
2240 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2241 x - relief, y - relief,
2242 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2243 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2244 }
2245 }
2246 }
2247 else
2248 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2249 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2250 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2251 }
2252
2253
2254 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2255
2256 static void
2257 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2258 {
2259 int x1, y1, thick, raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p;
2260 XRectangle r;
2261 int x = s->x;
2262 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2263
2264 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2265 right of that line. */
2266 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2267 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2268 && s->slice.x == 0)
2269 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2270
2271 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2272 by that margin. */
2273 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2274 x += s->img->hmargin;
2275 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2276 y += s->img->vmargin;
2277
2278 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2279 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2280 {
2281 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2282 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2283 }
2284 else
2285 {
2286 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2287 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2288 }
2289
2290 x1 = x + s->slice.width - 1;
2291 y1 = y + s->slice.height - 1;
2292 top_p = bot_p = left_p = right_p = 0;
2293
2294 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2295 x -= thick, left_p = 1;
2296 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2297 y -= thick, top_p = 1;
2298 if (s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width)
2299 x1 += thick, right_p = 1;
2300 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height)
2301 y1 += thick, bot_p = 1;
2302
2303 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2304 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2305 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x, y, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2306 top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, &r);
2307 }
2308
2309
2310 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2311
2312 static void
2313 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2314 {
2315 int x = 0;
2316 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2317
2318 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2319 right of that line. */
2320 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2321 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2322 && s->slice.x == 0)
2323 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2324
2325 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2326 by that margin. */
2327 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2328 x += s->img->hmargin;
2329 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2330 y += s->img->vmargin;
2331
2332 if (s->img->pixmap)
2333 {
2334 if (s->img->mask)
2335 {
2336 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2337 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2338 trust on the shape extension to be available
2339 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2340 manually. */
2341 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2342 | GCFunction);
2343 XGCValues xgcv;
2344
2345 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2346 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2347 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2348 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2349 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2350
2351 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2352 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2353 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2354 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2355 }
2356 else
2357 {
2358 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2359 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2360 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2361
2362 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2363 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2364 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2365 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2366 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2367 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2368 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2369 {
2370 int r = eabs (s->img->relief);
2371 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2372 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2373 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2374 }
2375 }
2376 }
2377 else
2378 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2379 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2380 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2381 }
2382
2383
2384 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2385 give the rectangle to draw. */
2386
2387 static void
2388 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2389 {
2390 if (s->stippled_p)
2391 {
2392 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2393 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2394 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2395 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2396 }
2397 else
2398 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2399 }
2400
2401
2402 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2403
2404 s->y
2405 s->x +-------------------------
2406 | s->face->box
2407 |
2408 | +-------------------------
2409 | | s->img->margin
2410 | |
2411 | | +-------------------
2412 | | | the image
2413
2414 */
2415
2416 static void
2417 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2418 {
2419 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2420 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2421 int height;
2422 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2423
2424 height = s->height;
2425 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2426 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2427 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2428 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2429
2430 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2431 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2432 flickering. */
2433 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2434 if (height > s->slice.height
2435 || s->img->hmargin
2436 || s->img->vmargin
2437 || s->img->mask
2438 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2439 || s->width != s->background_width)
2440 {
2441 if (s->img->mask)
2442 {
2443 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2444 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2445 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2446 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2447 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2448
2449 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2450 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2451 s->background_width,
2452 s->height, depth);
2453
2454 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2455 pixmap. */
2456 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2457
2458 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2459 if (s->stippled_p)
2460 {
2461 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2462 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2463 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2464 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2465 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2466 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2467 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2468 }
2469 else
2470 {
2471 XGCValues xgcv;
2472 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2473 &xgcv);
2474 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2475 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2476 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2477 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2478 }
2479 }
2480 else
2481 {
2482 int x = s->x;
2483 int y = s->y;
2484
2485 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2486 && s->slice.x == 0)
2487 x += box_line_hwidth;
2488
2489 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2490 y += box_line_vwidth;
2491
2492 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2493 }
2494
2495 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2496 }
2497
2498 /* Draw the foreground. */
2499 if (pixmap != None)
2500 {
2501 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2502 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2503 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2504 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2505 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2506 }
2507 else
2508 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2509
2510 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2511 if (s->img->relief
2512 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2513 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2514 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2515 }
2516
2517
2518 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2519
2520 static void
2521 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2522 {
2523 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2524
2525 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2526 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2527 {
2528 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2529 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2530 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2531 int x = s->x;
2532
2533 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2534 {
2535 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2536
2537 if (x < left_x)
2538 {
2539 background_width -= left_x - x;
2540 x = left_x;
2541 }
2542 }
2543 else
2544 {
2545 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2546 stretch glyph. */
2547 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2548
2549 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2550 background_width -= x - right_x;
2551 x += background_width;
2552 }
2553 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2554 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2555 x -= width;
2556
2557 /* Draw cursor. */
2558 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2559
2560 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2561 if (width < background_width)
2562 {
2563 int y = s->y;
2564 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2565 XRectangle r;
2566 GC gc;
2567
2568 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2569 x += width;
2570 else
2571 x = s->x;
2572 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2573 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2574 {
2575 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2576 gc = s->gc;
2577 }
2578 else
2579 gc = s->face->gc;
2580
2581 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2582 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2583
2584 if (s->face->stipple)
2585 {
2586 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2587 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2588 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2589 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2590 }
2591 else
2592 {
2593 XGCValues xgcv;
2594 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2595 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2596 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2597 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2598 }
2599 }
2600 }
2601 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2602 {
2603 int background_width = s->background_width;
2604 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2605
2606 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2607 except for header line and mode line. */
2608 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2609 {
2610 background_width -= left_x - x;
2611 x = left_x;
2612 }
2613 if (background_width > 0)
2614 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2615 }
2616
2617 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2618 }
2619
2620 /*
2621 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2622
2623 x0 wave_length = 2
2624 --
2625 y0 * * * * *
2626 |* * * * * * * * *
2627 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2628
2629 */
2630
2631 static void
2632 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2633 {
2634 int wave_height = 2, wave_length = 3;
2635 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, odd, xmax;
2636 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2637
2638 dx = wave_length;
2639 dy = wave_height - 1;
2640 x0 = s->x;
2641 y0 = s->ybase + 1;
2642 width = s->width;
2643 xmax = x0 + width;
2644
2645 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2646
2647 wave_clip = (XRectangle){ x0, y0, width, wave_height };
2648 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2649
2650 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2651 return;
2652
2653 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2654
2655 /* Draw the waves */
2656
2657 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2658 x2 = x1 + dx;
2659 odd = (x1/dx) % 2;
2660 y1 = y2 = y0;
2661
2662 if (odd)
2663 y1 += dy;
2664 else
2665 y2 += dy;
2666
2667 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2668 emacs_abort ();
2669
2670 while (x1 <= xmax)
2671 {
2672 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2673 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2674 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2675 odd = !odd;
2676 }
2677
2678 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2679 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2680 }
2681
2682
2683 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2684
2685 static void
2686 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2687 {
2688 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2689
2690 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2691 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2692 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2693 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2694 {
2695 int width;
2696 struct glyph_string *next;
2697
2698 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2699 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2700 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2701 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2702 {
2703 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2704 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2705 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2706 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2707 else
2708 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2709 next->num_clips = 0;
2710 }
2711 }
2712
2713 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2714 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2715
2716 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2717 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2718 if (!s->for_overlaps
2719 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2720 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2721 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2722
2723 {
2724 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2725 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2726 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2727 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2728 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2729 }
2730 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2731 && !s->clip_tail
2732 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2733 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2734 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2735 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2736 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2737 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2738 else
2739 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2740
2741 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2742 {
2743 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2744 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2745 break;
2746
2747 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2748 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2749 break;
2750
2751 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2752 if (s->for_overlaps)
2753 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2754 else
2755 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2756 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2757 break;
2758
2759 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2760 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2761 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2762 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2763 else
2764 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2765 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2766 break;
2767
2768 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2769 if (s->for_overlaps)
2770 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2771 else
2772 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2773 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2774 break;
2775
2776 default:
2777 emacs_abort ();
2778 }
2779
2780 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2781 {
2782 /* Draw underline. */
2783 if (s->face->underline_p)
2784 {
2785 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2786 {
2787 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2788 x_draw_underwave (s);
2789 else
2790 {
2791 XGCValues xgcv;
2792 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2793 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2794 x_draw_underwave (s);
2795 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2796 }
2797 }
2798 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2799 {
2800 unsigned long thickness, position;
2801 int y;
2802
2803 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2804 {
2805 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2806 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2807 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2808 }
2809 else
2810 {
2811 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2812 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2813 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2814 else
2815 thickness = 1;
2816 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2817 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2818 else
2819 {
2820 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2821 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2822 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2823 specs, and its default is
2824
2825 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2826 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2827
2828 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2829 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2830 position = s->font->underline_position;
2831 else if (s->font)
2832 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2833 else
2834 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2835 }
2836 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2837 }
2838 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2839 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2840 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2841 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2842 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2843 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2844 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2845 s->underline_position = position;
2846 y = s->ybase + position;
2847 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2848 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2849 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2850 else
2851 {
2852 XGCValues xgcv;
2853 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2854 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2855 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2856 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2857 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2858 }
2859 }
2860 }
2861 /* Draw overline. */
2862 if (s->face->overline_p)
2863 {
2864 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2865
2866 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2867 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2868 s->width, h);
2869 else
2870 {
2871 XGCValues xgcv;
2872 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2873 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2874 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2875 s->width, h);
2876 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2877 }
2878 }
2879
2880 /* Draw strike-through. */
2881 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2882 {
2883 unsigned long h = 1;
2884 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2885
2886 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2887 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2888 s->width, h);
2889 else
2890 {
2891 XGCValues xgcv;
2892 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2893 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2894 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2895 s->width, h);
2896 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2897 }
2898 }
2899
2900 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2901 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2902 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2903
2904 if (s->prev)
2905 {
2906 struct glyph_string *prev;
2907
2908 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2909 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2910 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2911 {
2912 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2913 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2914 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2915
2916 prev->hl = s->hl;
2917 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2918 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2919 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2920 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2921 else
2922 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2923 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2924 prev->hl = save;
2925 prev->num_clips = 0;
2926 }
2927 }
2928
2929 if (s->next)
2930 {
2931 struct glyph_string *next;
2932
2933 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2934 if (next->hl != s->hl
2935 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2936 {
2937 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2938 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2939 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2940
2941 next->hl = s->hl;
2942 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2943 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2944 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2945 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2946 else
2947 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2948 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2949 next->hl = save;
2950 next->num_clips = 0;
2951 next->clip_head = s->next;
2952 }
2953 }
2954 }
2955
2956 /* Reset clipping. */
2957 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2958 s->num_clips = 0;
2959 }
2960
2961 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2962
2963 static void
2964 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2965 {
2966 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2967 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2968 x, y, width, height,
2969 x + shift_by, y);
2970 }
2971
2972 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2973 for X frames. */
2974
2975 static void
2976 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2977 {
2978 emacs_abort ();
2979 }
2980
2981
2982 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2983 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2984
2985 void
2986 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2987 {
2988 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2989 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2990 }
2991
2992
2993 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2994
2995 static void
2996 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2997 {
2998 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2999 longer visible. */
3000 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3001 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3002 output_cursor.x = -1;
3003
3004 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3005 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3006 block_input ();
3007
3008 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3009
3010 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
3011 something like that, then they should be notified. */
3012 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3013
3014 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3015 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
3016 redisplay, do it here. */
3017 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
3018 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3019 #endif
3020
3021 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3022
3023 unblock_input ();
3024 }
3025
3026
3027 \f
3028 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3029
3030 static void
3031 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3032 {
3033 block_input ();
3034
3035 {
3036 #ifdef USE_GTK
3037 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3038 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3039 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3040 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3041 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3042 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3043 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3044 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3045 do { \
3046 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3047 cairo_fill (cr); \
3048 } \
3049 while (0)
3050 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3051 GdkGCValues vals;
3052 GdkGC *gc;
3053 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3054 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3055 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3056 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3057 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3058 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3059 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3060 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3061 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3062 GC gc;
3063
3064 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3065 pixels into background pixels. */
3066 {
3067 XGCValues values;
3068
3069 values.function = GXxor;
3070 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3071 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3072
3073 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3074 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3075 }
3076 #endif
3077 {
3078 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3079 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3080 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3081 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3082 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3083 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3084 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3085
3086 int width;
3087
3088 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3089 edge it is next to. */
3090 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3091 {
3092 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3093 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3094 break;
3095
3096 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3097 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3098 break;
3099
3100 default:
3101 break;
3102 }
3103
3104 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3105
3106 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3107 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3108 {
3109 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3110 flash_left,
3111 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3112 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3113 width, flash_height);
3114 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3115 flash_left,
3116 (height - flash_height
3117 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3118 width, flash_height);
3119
3120 }
3121 else
3122 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3123 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3124 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3125 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3126
3127 x_flush (f);
3128
3129 {
3130 EMACS_TIME delay = make_emacs_time (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3131 EMACS_TIME wakeup = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), delay);
3132
3133 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3134 available. */
3135 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3136 {
3137 EMACS_TIME current = current_emacs_time ();
3138 EMACS_TIME timeout;
3139
3140 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3141 if (EMACS_TIME_LE (wakeup, current))
3142 break;
3143
3144 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3145 timeout = make_emacs_time (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3146
3147 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3148 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3149 }
3150 }
3151
3152 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3153 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3154 {
3155 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3156 flash_left,
3157 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3158 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3159 width, flash_height);
3160 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3161 flash_left,
3162 (height - flash_height
3163 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3164 width, flash_height);
3165 }
3166 else
3167 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3168 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3169 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3170 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3171
3172 #ifdef USE_GTK
3173 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3174 cairo_destroy (cr);
3175 #else
3176 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3177 #endif
3178 #undef XFillRectangle
3179 #else
3180 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3181 #endif
3182 x_flush (f);
3183 }
3184 }
3185
3186 unblock_input ();
3187 }
3188
3189
3190 static void
3191 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3192 {
3193 block_input ();
3194 if (invisible)
3195 {
3196 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3197 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3198 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3199 }
3200 else
3201 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3202 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3203 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3204 unblock_input ();
3205 }
3206
3207
3208 /* Make audible bell. */
3209
3210 static void
3211 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3212 {
3213 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3214 {
3215 if (visible_bell)
3216 XTflash (f);
3217 else
3218 {
3219 block_input ();
3220 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3221 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3222 unblock_input ();
3223 }
3224 }
3225 }
3226
3227 \f
3228 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3229 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3230 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3231 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3232
3233 static void
3234 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3235 {
3236 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3237 }
3238
3239
3240 \f
3241 /***********************************************************************
3242 Line Dance
3243 ***********************************************************************/
3244
3245 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3246 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3247
3248 static void
3249 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3250 {
3251 emacs_abort ();
3252 }
3253
3254
3255 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3256
3257 static void
3258 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3259 {
3260 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3261 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3262
3263 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3264 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3265 fringe of W. */
3266 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3267
3268 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3269 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3270 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3271 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3272 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3273 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3274 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3275 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3276 {
3277 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3278
3279 if (sb_width > 0)
3280 {
3281 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3282 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3283 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3284
3285 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3286 {
3287 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3288 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3289 }
3290 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3291 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3292 }
3293 }
3294 #endif
3295
3296 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3297 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3298 bottom_y = y + height;
3299
3300 if (to_y < from_y)
3301 {
3302 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3303 line at the bottom. */
3304 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3305 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3306 else
3307 height = run->height;
3308 }
3309 else
3310 {
3311 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3312 at the bottom. */
3313 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3314 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3315 else
3316 height = run->height;
3317 }
3318
3319 block_input ();
3320
3321 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3322 updated_window = w;
3323 x_clear_cursor (w);
3324
3325 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3326 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3327 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3328 x, from_y,
3329 width, height,
3330 x, to_y);
3331
3332 unblock_input ();
3333 }
3334
3335
3336 \f
3337 /***********************************************************************
3338 Exposure Events
3339 ***********************************************************************/
3340
3341 \f
3342 static void
3343 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3344 {
3345 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3346 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3347 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3348 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3349 block_input ();
3350 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3351 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3352 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3353 because of this (bug#9310). */
3354 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3355 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3356 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3357 x_uncatch_errors ();
3358 unblock_input ();
3359 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3360 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3361 }
3362
3363 static void
3364 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3365 {
3366 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3367 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3368 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3369 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3370 block_input ();
3371 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3372 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3373 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3374 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3375 x_uncatch_errors ();
3376 unblock_input ();
3377 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3378 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3379 }
3380
3381 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3382 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3383 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3384 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3385 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3386
3387 static void
3388 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3389 {
3390 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3391
3392 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3393 {
3394 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3395 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3396 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3397
3398 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3399 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3400
3401 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3402 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3403 else
3404 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3405 }
3406
3407 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3408 }
3409
3410 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3411 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3412 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3413
3414 static void
3415 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3416 {
3417 if (type == FocusIn)
3418 {
3419 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3420 {
3421 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3422 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3423
3424 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3425 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3426 /* When run as a daemon, Vterminal_frame is always NIL. */
3427 if ((NILP (Vterminal_frame) || EQ (Fdaemonp(), Qt))
3428 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3429 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3430 {
3431 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3432 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3433 }
3434 }
3435
3436 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3437
3438 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3439 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3440 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3441 #endif
3442 }
3443 else if (type == FocusOut)
3444 {
3445 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3446
3447 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3448 {
3449 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3450 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3451 }
3452
3453 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3454 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3455 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3456 #endif
3457 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3458 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3459 }
3460 }
3461
3462 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3463 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3464
3465 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3466
3467 static void
3468 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3469 {
3470 struct frame *frame;
3471
3472 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3473 if (! frame)
3474 return;
3475
3476 switch (event->type)
3477 {
3478 case EnterNotify:
3479 case LeaveNotify:
3480 {
3481 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3482 int focus_state
3483 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3484
3485 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3486 && event->xcrossing.focus
3487 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3488 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3489 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3490 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3491 }
3492 break;
3493
3494 case FocusIn:
3495 case FocusOut:
3496 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3497 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3498 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3499 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3500 break;
3501
3502 case ClientMessage:
3503 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3504 {
3505 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3506 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3507 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3508 }
3509 break;
3510 }
3511 }
3512
3513
3514 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3515 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3516
3517 void
3518 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3519 {
3520 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3521 }
3522 #endif
3523
3524 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3525 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3526 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3527
3528 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3529 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3530 the appropriate X display info. */
3531
3532 static void
3533 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3534 {
3535 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3536 }
3537
3538 static void
3539 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3540 {
3541 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3542
3543 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3544 {
3545 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3546 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3547 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3548 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3549 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3550 {
3551 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame, Qnil);
3552 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3553 }
3554 }
3555 else
3556 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3557
3558 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3559 {
3560 if (old_highlight)
3561 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3562 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3563 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3564 }
3565 }
3566
3567
3568 \f
3569 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3570
3571 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3572 static void
3573 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3574 {
3575 int min_code, max_code;
3576 KeySym *syms;
3577 int syms_per_code;
3578 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3579
3580 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3581 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3582 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3583 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3584 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3585
3586 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3587
3588 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3589 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3590 &syms_per_code);
3591 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3592
3593 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3594 Alt keysyms are on. */
3595 {
3596 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3597 int found_alt_or_meta;
3598
3599 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3600 {
3601 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3602 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3603 {
3604 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3605
3606 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3607 if (code == 0)
3608 continue;
3609
3610 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3611 {
3612 int code_col;
3613
3614 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3615 {
3616 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3617
3618 switch (sym)
3619 {
3620 case XK_Meta_L:
3621 case XK_Meta_R:
3622 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3623 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3624 break;
3625
3626 case XK_Alt_L:
3627 case XK_Alt_R:
3628 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3629 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3630 break;
3631
3632 case XK_Hyper_L:
3633 case XK_Hyper_R:
3634 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3635 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3636 code_col = syms_per_code;
3637 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3638 break;
3639
3640 case XK_Super_L:
3641 case XK_Super_R:
3642 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3643 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3644 code_col = syms_per_code;
3645 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3646 break;
3647
3648 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3649 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3650 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3651 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3652 code_col = syms_per_code;
3653 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3654 break;
3655 }
3656 }
3657 }
3658 }
3659 }
3660 }
3661
3662 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3663 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3664 {
3665 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3666 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3667 }
3668
3669 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3670 make them just meta, not alt. */
3671 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3672 {
3673 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3674 }
3675
3676 XFree (syms);
3677 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3678 }
3679
3680 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3681 Emacs uses. */
3682
3683 int
3684 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3685 {
3686 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3687 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3688 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3689 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3690 Lisp_Object tem;
3691
3692 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3693 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3694 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3695 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3696 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3697 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3698 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3699 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3700
3701 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3702 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3703 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3704 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3705 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3706 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3707 }
3708
3709 static int
3710 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3711 {
3712 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3713 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3714 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3715 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3716
3717 Lisp_Object tem;
3718
3719 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3720 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3721 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3722 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3723 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3724 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3725 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3726 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3727
3728
3729 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3730 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3731 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3732 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3733 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3734 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3735 }
3736
3737 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3738
3739 char *
3740 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3741 {
3742 char *value;
3743
3744 block_input ();
3745 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3746 unblock_input ();
3747
3748 return value;
3749 }
3750
3751
3752 \f
3753 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3754
3755 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3756
3757 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3758 the mouse. */
3759
3760 static Lisp_Object
3761 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3762 {
3763 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3764 otherwise. */
3765 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3766 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3767 result->timestamp = event->time;
3768 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3769 event->state)
3770 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3771 ? up_modifier
3772 : down_modifier));
3773
3774 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3775 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3776 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3777 result->arg = Qnil;
3778 return Qnil;
3779 }
3780
3781 \f
3782 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3783 The input handler calls this.
3784
3785 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3786 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3787 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3788 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3789
3790 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3791 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3792
3793 static int
3794 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3795 {
3796 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3797 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3798 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3799
3800 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3801 return 0;
3802
3803 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3804 {
3805 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3806 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3807 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3808 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3809 return 1;
3810 }
3811
3812
3813 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3814 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3815 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3816 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3817 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3818 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3819 {
3820 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3821 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3822 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3823 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3824 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3825 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3826 return 1;
3827 }
3828
3829 return 0;
3830 }
3831
3832 \f
3833 /************************************************************************
3834 Mouse Face
3835 ************************************************************************/
3836
3837 static void
3838 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3839 {
3840 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3841 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3842 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3843 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3844 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3845 }
3846
3847
3848
3849 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3850 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3851
3852 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3853 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3854 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3855 position on the scroll bar.
3856
3857 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3858 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3859 the mouse is over.
3860
3861 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3862 was at this position.
3863
3864 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3865
3866 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3867 movement. */
3868
3869 static void
3870 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3871 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3872 Time *timestamp)
3873 {
3874 FRAME_PTR f1;
3875
3876 block_input ();
3877
3878 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3879 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3880 else
3881 {
3882 Window root;
3883 int root_x, root_y;
3884
3885 Window dummy_window;
3886 int dummy;
3887
3888 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3889
3890 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3891 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3892 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3893 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3894 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3895
3896 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3897
3898 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3899 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3900 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3901
3902 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3903 &root,
3904
3905 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3906 a different screen. */
3907 &dummy_window,
3908
3909 /* The position on that root window. */
3910 &root_x, &root_y,
3911
3912 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3913 &dummy, &dummy,
3914
3915 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3916 we don't care. */
3917 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3918
3919 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3920 containing the pointer. */
3921 {
3922 Window win, child;
3923 int win_x, win_y;
3924 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3925
3926 win = root;
3927
3928 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3929 structure is changing at the same time this function
3930 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3931
3932 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3933
3934 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3935 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3936 {
3937 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3938 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3939 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3940
3941 /* From-window, to-window. */
3942 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3943
3944 /* From-position, to-position. */
3945 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3946
3947 /* Child of win. */
3948 &child);
3949 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3950 }
3951 else
3952 {
3953 while (1)
3954 {
3955 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3956
3957 /* From-window, to-window. */
3958 root, win,
3959
3960 /* From-position, to-position. */
3961 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3962
3963 /* Child of win. */
3964 &child);
3965
3966 if (child == None || child == win)
3967 break;
3968 #ifdef USE_GTK
3969 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3970 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3971 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3972 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3973 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3974 break;
3975 #endif
3976 win = child;
3977 parent_x = win_x;
3978 parent_y = win_y;
3979 }
3980
3981 /* Now we know that:
3982 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3983 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3984 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3985 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3986 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3987 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3988 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3989 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3990 never use them in that case.) */
3991
3992 #ifdef USE_GTK
3993 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3994 want the edit window. */
3995 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3996 #else
3997 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3998 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3999 #endif
4000
4001 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4002 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4003 on the frame. */
4004 if (f1 != NULL
4005 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4006 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4007 f1 = NULL;
4008 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4009 }
4010
4011 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4012 f1 = 0;
4013
4014 x_uncatch_errors ();
4015
4016 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4017 if (! f1)
4018 {
4019 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4020
4021 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4022
4023 if (bar)
4024 {
4025 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4026 win_x = parent_x;
4027 win_y = parent_y;
4028 }
4029 }
4030
4031 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4032 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4033
4034 if (f1)
4035 {
4036 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4037 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4038 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4039 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4040 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4041 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4042 the frame are divided into. */
4043
4044 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4045 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4046
4047 *bar_window = Qnil;
4048 *part = 0;
4049 *fp = f1;
4050 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4051 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4052 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4053 }
4054 }
4055 }
4056
4057 unblock_input ();
4058 }
4059
4060
4061 \f
4062 /***********************************************************************
4063 Scroll bars
4064 ***********************************************************************/
4065
4066 /* Scroll bar support. */
4067
4068 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4069 manages it.
4070 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4071 bits. */
4072
4073 static struct scroll_bar *
4074 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4075 {
4076 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4077
4078 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4079 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4080 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4081
4082 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4083 {
4084 Lisp_Object bar, condemned;
4085
4086 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4087 continue;
4088
4089 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4090 right window ID. */
4091 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4092 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4093 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4094 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4095 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4096 condemned = Qnil,
4097 ! NILP (bar));
4098 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4099 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4100 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4101 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4102 }
4103
4104 return NULL;
4105 }
4106
4107
4108 #if defined USE_LUCID
4109
4110 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4111 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4112
4113 static Widget
4114 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4115 {
4116 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4117
4118 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4119 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4120 {
4121 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4122
4123 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4124 return menu_bar;
4125 }
4126 return NULL;
4127 }
4128
4129 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4130
4131 \f
4132 /************************************************************************
4133 Toolkit scroll bars
4134 ************************************************************************/
4135
4136 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4137
4138 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4139 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4140 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4141 struct scroll_bar *);
4142 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4143 int, int, int);
4144
4145
4146 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4147 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4148
4149 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4150
4151 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4152
4153 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4154
4155 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4156 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4157
4158 #ifndef USE_GTK
4159 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4160
4161 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4162
4163 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4164
4165 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4166 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4167 to avoid jerkiness. */
4168
4169 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4170
4171 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4172 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4173 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4174 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4175
4176 static void
4177 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4178 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4179 {
4180 int scroll_bar_p;
4181 const char *end_action;
4182
4183 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4184 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4185 end_action = "Release";
4186 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4187 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4188 end_action = "EndScroll";
4189 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4190
4191 if (scroll_bar_p
4192 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4193 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4194 {
4195 struct window *w;
4196
4197 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4198 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4199 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4200
4201 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4202 {
4203 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4204 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4205 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4206 }
4207 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4208 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4209
4210 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4211 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4212 }
4213 }
4214 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4215
4216 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4217 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4218
4219 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4220 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4221
4222
4223 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4224 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4225 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4226 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4227
4228 static void
4229 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4230 {
4231 XEvent event;
4232 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4233 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4234 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4235 ptrdiff_t i;
4236
4237 block_input ();
4238
4239 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4240 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4241 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4242 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4243 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4244 ev->format = 32;
4245
4246 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4247 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4248 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4249 into that array in the event. */
4250 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4251 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4252 break;
4253
4254 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4255 {
4256 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4257 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4258 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4259 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4260 scroll_bar_windows =
4261 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4262 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4263 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4264 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4265 }
4266
4267 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4268 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4269 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4270 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4271 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4272 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4273
4274 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4275 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4276 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4277 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4278 #endif
4279
4280 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4281 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4282 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4283 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4284 unblock_input ();
4285 }
4286
4287
4288 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4289 in *IEVENT. */
4290
4291 static void
4292 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4293 {
4294 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4295 Lisp_Object window;
4296 struct window *w;
4297
4298 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4299 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4300
4301 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4302
4303 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4304 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4305 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4306 #ifdef USE_GTK
4307 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4308 #else
4309 ievent->timestamp =
4310 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4311 #endif
4312 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4313 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4314 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4315 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4316 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4317 }
4318
4319
4320 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4321
4322 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4323
4324 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4325
4326
4327 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4328 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4329 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4330
4331 static void
4332 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4333 {
4334 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4335 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4336 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4337
4338 switch (cs->reason)
4339 {
4340 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4341 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4342 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4343 break;
4344
4345 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4346 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4347 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4348 break;
4349
4350 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4351 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4352 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4353 break;
4354
4355 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4356 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4357 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4358 break;
4359
4360 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4361 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4362 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4363 break;
4364
4365 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4366 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4367 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4368 break;
4369
4370 case XmCR_DRAG:
4371 {
4372 int slider_size;
4373
4374 /* Get the slider size. */
4375 block_input ();
4376 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4377 unblock_input ();
4378
4379 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4380 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4381 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4382 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4383 }
4384 break;
4385
4386 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4387 break;
4388 };
4389
4390 if (part >= 0)
4391 {
4392 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4393 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4394 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4395 }
4396 }
4397
4398 #elif defined USE_GTK
4399
4400 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4401 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4402
4403 static gboolean
4404 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4405 GtkScrollType scroll,
4406 gdouble value,
4407 gpointer user_data)
4408 {
4409 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4410 gdouble position;
4411 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4412 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4413 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4414
4415 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4416 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4417
4418
4419 switch (scroll)
4420 {
4421 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4422 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4423 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4424 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4425 {
4426 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4427 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4428 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4429 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4430 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4431 }
4432 break;
4433 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4434 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4435 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4436 break;
4437 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4438 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4439 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4440 break;
4441 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4442 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4443 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4444 break;
4445 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4446 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4447 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4448 break;
4449 }
4450
4451 if (part >= 0)
4452 {
4453 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4454 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4455 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4456 }
4457
4458 return FALSE;
4459 }
4460
4461 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4462
4463 static gboolean
4464 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4465 GdkEventButton *event,
4466 gpointer user_data)
4467 {
4468 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4469 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4470 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4471 {
4472 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4473 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4474 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4475 }
4476
4477 return FALSE;
4478 }
4479
4480
4481 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4482
4483 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4484 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4485 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4486 the thumb is. */
4487
4488 static void
4489 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4490 {
4491 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4492 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4493 float shown;
4494 int whole, portion, height;
4495 int part;
4496
4497 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4498 block_input ();
4499 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4500 unblock_input ();
4501
4502 whole = 10000000;
4503 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4504
4505 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4506 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4507 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4508 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4509 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4510 bottom). */
4511 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4512 else
4513 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4514
4515 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4516 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4517 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4518 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4519 }
4520
4521
4522 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4523 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4524 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4525 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4526 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4527 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4528 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4529
4530 static void
4531 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4532 {
4533 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4534 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4535 int position = (long) call_data;
4536 Dimension height;
4537 int part;
4538
4539 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4540 block_input ();
4541 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4542 unblock_input ();
4543
4544 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4545 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4546
4547 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4548 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4549 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4550 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4551 else
4552 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4553
4554 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4555 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4556 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4557 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4558 }
4559
4560 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4561
4562 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4563
4564 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4565 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4566
4567 #ifdef USE_GTK
4568 static void
4569 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4570 {
4571 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4572
4573 block_input ();
4574 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4575 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4576 scroll_bar_name);
4577 unblock_input ();
4578 }
4579
4580 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4581
4582 static void
4583 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4584 {
4585 Window xwindow;
4586 Widget widget;
4587 Arg av[20];
4588 int ac = 0;
4589 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4590 unsigned long pixel;
4591
4592 block_input ();
4593
4594 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4595 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4596 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4597 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4598 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4599 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4600 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4601 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4602 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4603
4604 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4605 if (pixel != -1)
4606 {
4607 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4608 ++ac;
4609 }
4610
4611 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4612 if (pixel != -1)
4613 {
4614 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4615 ++ac;
4616 }
4617
4618 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4619 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4620
4621 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4622 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4623 (XtPointer) bar);
4624 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4625 (XtPointer) bar);
4626 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4627 (XtPointer) bar);
4628 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4629 (XtPointer) bar);
4630 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4631 (XtPointer) bar);
4632 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4633 (XtPointer) bar);
4634 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4635 (XtPointer) bar);
4636
4637 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4638 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4639
4640 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4641 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4642 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4643 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4644
4645 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4646
4647 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4648 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4649 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4650 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4651 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4652 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4653 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4654 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4655
4656 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4657 if (pixel != -1)
4658 {
4659 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4660 ++ac;
4661 }
4662
4663 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4664 if (pixel != -1)
4665 {
4666 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4667 ++ac;
4668 }
4669
4670 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4671
4672 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4673 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4674 {
4675 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4676 if (pixel != -1)
4677 {
4678 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4679 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4680 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4681 pixel = -1;
4682 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4683 }
4684 }
4685 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4686 {
4687 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4688 if (pixel != -1)
4689 {
4690 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4691 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4692 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4693 pixel = -1;
4694 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4695 }
4696 }
4697
4698 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4699 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4700 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4701 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4702 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4703 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4704 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4705 colors itself. */
4706 {
4707 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4708 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4709 ++ac;
4710 }
4711 else
4712 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4713 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4714 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4715 {
4716 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4717 the shadows. */
4718 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4719 ++ac;
4720
4721 /* Specify the colors. */
4722 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4723 if (pixel != -1)
4724 {
4725 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4726 ++ac;
4727 }
4728 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4729 if (pixel != -1)
4730 {
4731 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4732 ++ac;
4733 }
4734 }
4735 #endif
4736
4737 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4738 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4739
4740 {
4741 char const *initial = "";
4742 char const *val = initial;
4743 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4744 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4745 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4746 #endif
4747 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4748 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4749 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4750 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4751 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4752 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4753 }
4754 }
4755
4756 /* Define callbacks. */
4757 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4758 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4759 (XtPointer) bar);
4760
4761 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4762 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4763
4764 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4765
4766 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4767 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4768 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4769 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4770
4771 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4772 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4773 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4774 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4775
4776 unblock_input ();
4777 }
4778 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4779
4780
4781 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4782 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4783
4784 #ifdef USE_GTK
4785 static void
4786 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4787 {
4788 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4789 }
4790
4791 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4792 static void
4793 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4794 int whole)
4795 {
4796 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4797 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4798 float top, shown;
4799
4800 block_input ();
4801
4802 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4803
4804 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4805 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4806 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4807 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4808 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4809 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4810 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4811 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4812 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4813 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4814 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4815 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4816 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4817 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4818 whole += portion;
4819
4820 if (whole <= 0)
4821 top = 0, shown = 1;
4822 else
4823 {
4824 top = (float) position / whole;
4825 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4826 }
4827
4828 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4829 {
4830 int size, value;
4831
4832 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4833 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4834 value. */
4835 size = clip_to_bounds (1, shown * XM_SB_MAX, XM_SB_MAX);
4836
4837 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4838 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4839 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4840
4841 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4842 }
4843 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4844
4845 if (whole == 0)
4846 top = 0, shown = 1;
4847 else
4848 {
4849 top = (float) position / whole;
4850 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4851 }
4852
4853 {
4854 float old_top, old_shown;
4855 Dimension height;
4856 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4857 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4858 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4859 XtNheight, &height,
4860 NULL);
4861
4862 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4863 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4864 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4865 else
4866 top = old_top;
4867 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4868 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
4869
4870 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4871 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4872 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4873 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4874 {
4875 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4876 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4877 else
4878 {
4879 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4880 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4881 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4882
4883 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4884 }
4885 }
4886 }
4887 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4888
4889 unblock_input ();
4890 }
4891 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4892
4893 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4894
4895
4896 \f
4897 /************************************************************************
4898 Scroll bars, general
4899 ************************************************************************/
4900
4901 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4902 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4903 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4904 scroll bar. */
4905
4906 static struct scroll_bar *
4907 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4908 {
4909 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4910 struct scroll_bar *bar
4911 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4912 Lisp_Object barobj;
4913
4914 block_input ();
4915
4916 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4917 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4918 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4919 {
4920 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4921 unsigned long mask;
4922 Window window;
4923
4924 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4925 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4926 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4927
4928 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4929 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4930 | ExposureMask);
4931 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4932
4933 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4934
4935 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4936 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4937 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4938 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4939 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4940 left, top, width,
4941 window_box_height (w), False);
4942
4943 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4944 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4945 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4946 top,
4947 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4948 height,
4949 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4950 0,
4951 CopyFromParent,
4952 CopyFromParent,
4953 CopyFromParent,
4954 /* Attributes. */
4955 mask, &a);
4956 bar->x_window = window;
4957 }
4958 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4959
4960 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4961 bar->top = top;
4962 bar->left = left;
4963 bar->width = width;
4964 bar->height = height;
4965 bar->start = 0;
4966 bar->end = 0;
4967 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4968 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4969
4970 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4971 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4972 bar->prev = Qnil;
4973 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
4974 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
4975 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4976 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4977
4978 /* Map the window/widget. */
4979 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4980 {
4981 #ifdef USE_GTK
4982 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4983 bar->x_window,
4984 top,
4985 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4986 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4987 max (height, 1));
4988 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4989 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4990 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4991 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4992 top,
4993 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4994 max (height, 1), 0);
4995 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4996 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4997 }
4998 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4999 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5000 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5001
5002 unblock_input ();
5003 return bar;
5004 }
5005
5006
5007 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5008
5009 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5010
5011 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5012 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5013 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5014 events.)
5015
5016 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5017 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5018 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5019 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5020 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5021
5022 static void
5023 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5024 {
5025 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5026 Window w = bar->x_window;
5027 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5028 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5029
5030 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5031 if (! rebuild
5032 && start == bar->start
5033 && end == bar->end)
5034 return;
5035
5036 block_input ();
5037
5038 {
5039 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5040 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5041 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5042
5043 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5044 the distance between start and end. */
5045 {
5046 int length = end - start;
5047
5048 if (start < 0)
5049 start = 0;
5050 else if (start > top_range)
5051 start = top_range;
5052 end = start + length;
5053
5054 if (end < start)
5055 end = start;
5056 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5057 end = top_range;
5058 }
5059
5060 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5061 bar->start = start;
5062 bar->end = end;
5063
5064 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5065 if (end > top_range)
5066 end = top_range;
5067
5068 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5069 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5070 that many pixels tall. */
5071 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5072
5073 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5074 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5075 if (0 < start)
5076 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5077 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5078 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5079 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5080 inside_width, start,
5081 False);
5082
5083 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5084 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5085 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5086 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5087
5088 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5089 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5090 /* x, y, width, height */
5091 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5092 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5093 inside_width, end - start);
5094
5095 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5096 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5097 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5098 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5099
5100 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5101 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5102 if (end < inside_height)
5103 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5104 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5105 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5106 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5107 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5108 False);
5109
5110 }
5111
5112 unblock_input ();
5113 }
5114
5115 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5116
5117 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5118 nil. */
5119
5120 static void
5121 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5122 {
5123 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5124 block_input ();
5125
5126 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5127 #ifdef USE_GTK
5128 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5129 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5130 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5131 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5132 #else
5133 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5134 #endif
5135
5136 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5137 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
5138
5139 unblock_input ();
5140 }
5141
5142
5143 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5144 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5145 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5146 create one. */
5147
5148 static void
5149 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5150 {
5151 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5152 Lisp_Object barobj;
5153 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5154 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5155 int window_y, window_height;
5156 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5157 int fringe_extended_p;
5158 #endif
5159
5160 /* Get window dimensions. */
5161 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5162 top = window_y;
5163 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5164 height = window_height;
5165
5166 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5167 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5168
5169 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5170 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5171 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5172 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5173 else
5174 sb_width = width;
5175
5176 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5177 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5178 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5179 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5180 else
5181 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5182 #else
5183 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5184 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5185 else
5186 sb_left = left;
5187 #endif
5188
5189 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5190 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5191 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5192 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5193 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5194 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5195 else
5196 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5197 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5198 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5199 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5200 #endif
5201
5202 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5203 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5204 {
5205 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5206 {
5207 block_input ();
5208 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5209 if (fringe_extended_p)
5210 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5211 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5212 else
5213 #endif
5214 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5215 left, top, width, height, False);
5216 unblock_input ();
5217 }
5218
5219 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5220 }
5221 else
5222 {
5223 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5224 unsigned int mask = 0;
5225
5226 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5227
5228 block_input ();
5229
5230 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5231 mask |= CWX;
5232 if (top != bar->top)
5233 mask |= CWY;
5234 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5235 mask |= CWWidth;
5236 if (height != bar->height)
5237 mask |= CWHeight;
5238
5239 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5240
5241 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5242 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5243 {
5244 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5245 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5246 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5247 {
5248 if (fringe_extended_p)
5249 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5250 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5251 else
5252 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5253 left, top, width, height, False);
5254 }
5255 #ifdef USE_GTK
5256 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5257 bar->x_window,
5258 top,
5259 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5260 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5261 max (height, 1));
5262 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5263 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5264 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5265 top,
5266 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5267 max (height, 1), 0);
5268 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5269 }
5270 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5271
5272 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5273 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5274 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5275 {
5276 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5277 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5278 height, False);
5279 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5280 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5281 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5282 height, False);
5283 }
5284
5285 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5286 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5287 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5288 example. */
5289 {
5290 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5291 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5292 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5293 {
5294 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5295 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5296 left + area_width - rest, top,
5297 rest, height, False);
5298 else
5299 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5300 left, top, rest, height, False);
5301 }
5302 }
5303
5304 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5305 if (mask)
5306 {
5307 XWindowChanges wc;
5308
5309 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5310 wc.y = top;
5311 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5312 wc.height = height;
5313 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5314 mask, &wc);
5315 }
5316
5317 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5318
5319 /* Remember new settings. */
5320 bar->left = sb_left;
5321 bar->top = top;
5322 bar->width = sb_width;
5323 bar->height = height;
5324
5325 unblock_input ();
5326 }
5327
5328 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5329 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5330
5331 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5332 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5333 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5334 dragged. */
5335 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5336 {
5337 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5338
5339 if (whole == 0)
5340 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5341 else
5342 {
5343 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5344 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5345 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5346 }
5347 }
5348 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5349
5350 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5351 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
5352 }
5353
5354
5355 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5356 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5357 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5358 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5359 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5360 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5361 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5362
5363 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5364 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5365 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5366
5367 static void
5368 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5369 {
5370 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5371 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5372 {
5373 Lisp_Object bar;
5374 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5375 fset_scroll_bars (frame, XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next);
5376 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5377 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5378 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5379 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5380 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame, bar);
5381 }
5382 }
5383
5384
5385 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5386 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5387
5388 static void
5389 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5390 {
5391 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5392 struct frame *f;
5393 Lisp_Object barobj;
5394
5395 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5396 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5397 emacs_abort ();
5398
5399 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5400
5401 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5402 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5403 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5404 {
5405 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5406 the lists. */
5407 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5408 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5409 return;
5410 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5411 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5412 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
5413 else
5414 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5415 one or the other! */
5416 emacs_abort ();
5417 }
5418 else
5419 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5420
5421 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5422 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5423
5424 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5425 bar->prev = Qnil;
5426 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5427 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
5428 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5429 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5430 }
5431
5432 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5433 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5434
5435 static void
5436 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5437 {
5438 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5439
5440 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5441
5442 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5443 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5444 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, Qnil);
5445
5446 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5447 {
5448 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5449
5450 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5451
5452 next = b->next;
5453 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5454 }
5455
5456 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5457 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5458 }
5459
5460
5461 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5462 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5463 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5464
5465 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5466 mark bits. */
5467
5468 static void
5469 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5470 {
5471 Window w = bar->x_window;
5472 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5473 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5474 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5475
5476 block_input ();
5477
5478 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5479
5480 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5481 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5482 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5483 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5484
5485 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5486 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5487
5488 /* x, y, width, height */
5489 0, 0,
5490 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5491 bar->height - 1);
5492
5493 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5494 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5495 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5496 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5497
5498 unblock_input ();
5499
5500 }
5501 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5502
5503 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5504 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5505
5506 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5507 mark bits. */
5508
5509
5510 static void
5511 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5512 {
5513 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5514 emacs_abort ();
5515
5516 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5517 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5518 emacs_event->modifiers
5519 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5520 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5521 event->xbutton.state)
5522 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5523 ? up_modifier
5524 : down_modifier));
5525 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5526 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5527 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5528 {
5529 int top_range
5530 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5531 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5532
5533 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5534 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5535
5536 if (y < bar->start)
5537 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5538 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5539 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5540 else
5541 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5542
5543 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5544 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5545 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5546 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5547 {
5548 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5549 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5550
5551 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5552 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5553 }
5554 #endif
5555
5556 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5557 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5558 }
5559 }
5560
5561 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5562
5563 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5564
5565 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5566 mark bits. */
5567
5568 static void
5569 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5570 {
5571 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5572
5573 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5574
5575 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5576 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5577
5578 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5579 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5580 {
5581 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5582 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5583
5584 if (new_start != bar->start)
5585 {
5586 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5587
5588 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5589 }
5590 }
5591 }
5592
5593 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5594
5595 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5596 on the scroll bar. */
5597
5598 static void
5599 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5600 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5601 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5602 {
5603 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5604 Window w = bar->x_window;
5605 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5606 int win_x, win_y;
5607 Window dummy_window;
5608 int dummy_coord;
5609 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5610
5611 block_input ();
5612
5613 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5614 report that. */
5615 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5616
5617 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5618 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5619 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5620
5621 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5622 &win_x, &win_y,
5623
5624 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5625 &dummy_mask))
5626 ;
5627 else
5628 {
5629 int top_range
5630 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5631
5632 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5633
5634 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5635 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5636
5637 if (win_y < 0)
5638 win_y = 0;
5639 if (win_y > top_range)
5640 win_y = top_range;
5641
5642 *fp = f;
5643 *bar_window = bar->window;
5644
5645 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5646 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5647 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5648 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5649 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5650 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5651 else
5652 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5653
5654 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5655 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5656
5657 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5658 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5659 }
5660
5661 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5662
5663 unblock_input ();
5664 }
5665
5666
5667 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5668 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5669 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5670 redraw them. */
5671
5672 static void
5673 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5674 {
5675 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5676 Lisp_Object bar;
5677
5678 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5679 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5680 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5681 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5682 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5683 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5684 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5685 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5686 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5687 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5688 }
5689
5690 \f
5691 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5692
5693 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5694 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5695 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5696 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5697
5698 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5699 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5700
5701 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5702
5703 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5704 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5705
5706 static int temp_index;
5707 static short temp_buffer[100];
5708
5709 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5710 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5711 temp_index = 0; \
5712 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5713
5714 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5715 on a particular display. */
5716
5717 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5718
5719 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5720 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5721 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5722 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5723
5724 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5725
5726 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5727 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5728 do \
5729 { \
5730 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5731 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = \
5732 xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5733 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5734 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5735 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5736 } \
5737 while (0)
5738 #endif
5739
5740 enum
5741 {
5742 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5743 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5744 X_EVENT_DROP
5745 };
5746
5747 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5748 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5749 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5750
5751 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5752 this event further.
5753 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5754
5755 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5756 static int
5757 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5758 {
5759 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5760 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5761 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5762 was created. */
5763
5764 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5765 event->xclient.window);
5766
5767 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5768 }
5769 #endif
5770
5771 #ifdef USE_GTK
5772 static int current_count;
5773 static int current_finish;
5774 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5775
5776 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5777 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5778 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5779 static GdkFilterReturn
5780 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5781 {
5782 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5783
5784 block_input ();
5785 if (current_count >= 0)
5786 {
5787 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5788
5789 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5790
5791 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5792 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5793 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5794 so we do it here. */
5795 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5796 && dpyinfo
5797 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5798 {
5799 unblock_input ();
5800 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5801 }
5802 #endif
5803
5804 if (! dpyinfo)
5805 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5806 else
5807 current_count +=
5808 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5809 current_hold_quit);
5810 }
5811 else
5812 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5813
5814 unblock_input ();
5815
5816 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5817 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5818
5819 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5820 }
5821 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5822
5823
5824 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5825 enum xembed_message,
5826 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5827
5828 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5829
5830 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5831 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5832 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5833
5834 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5835
5836 static int
5837 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5838 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5839 {
5840 union {
5841 struct input_event ie;
5842 struct selection_input_event sie;
5843 } inev;
5844 int count = 0;
5845 int do_help = 0;
5846 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5847 struct frame *f = NULL;
5848 struct coding_system coding;
5849 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5850 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5851 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5852
5853 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5854
5855 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5856 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5857 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5858
5859 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5860 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5861
5862 switch (event.type)
5863 {
5864 case ClientMessage:
5865 {
5866 if (event.xclient.message_type
5867 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5868 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5869 {
5870 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5871 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5872 {
5873 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5874 could be the shell widget window
5875 if the frame has no title bar. */
5876 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5877 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5878 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5879 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5880 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5881 #endif
5882 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5883 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5884 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5885 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5886 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5887 needed.
5888
5889 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5890 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5891 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5892 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5893 Emacs. */
5894
5895 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5896 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5897 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5898 if (f)
5899 {
5900 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5901 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5902 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5903 x_catch_errors (d);
5904 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5905 /* The ICCCM says this is
5906 the only valid choice. */
5907 RevertToParent,
5908 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5909 /* This is needed to detect the error
5910 if there is an error. */
5911 XSync (d, False);
5912 x_uncatch_errors ();
5913 }
5914 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5915 #endif /* 0 */
5916 goto done;
5917 }
5918
5919 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5920 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5921 {
5922 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5923 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5924 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5925 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5926 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5927 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5928 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5929 session manager and one for this. */
5930 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5931 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5932 #endif
5933 {
5934 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5935 event.xclient.window);
5936 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5937 for a single Emacs process. */
5938 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5939 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5940 event.xclient.window,
5941 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5942 else if (f)
5943 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5944 event.xclient.window,
5945 0, 0);
5946 }
5947 goto done;
5948 }
5949
5950 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5951 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5952 {
5953 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5954 event.xclient.window);
5955 if (!f)
5956 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5957
5958 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5959 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5960 goto done;
5961 }
5962
5963 goto done;
5964 }
5965
5966 if (event.xclient.message_type
5967 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5968 {
5969 goto done;
5970 }
5971
5972 if (event.xclient.message_type
5973 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5974 {
5975 int new_x, new_y;
5976 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5977
5978 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5979 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5980
5981 if (f)
5982 {
5983 f->left_pos = new_x;
5984 f->top_pos = new_y;
5985 }
5986 goto done;
5987 }
5988
5989 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5990 if (event.xclient.message_type
5991 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5992 {
5993 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5994 if (f)
5995 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5996 &event, NULL);
5997 goto done;
5998 }
5999 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6000
6001 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6002 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6003 || (event.xclient.message_type
6004 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6005 {
6006 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6007 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6008 currently never do because we are interested in
6009 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6010 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6011 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6012 if (!f)
6013 goto OTHER;
6014 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6015 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6016 goto done;
6017 }
6018
6019 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6020 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6021 we construct an input_event. */
6022 if (event.xclient.message_type
6023 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6024 {
6025 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6026 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6027 goto done;
6028 }
6029 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6030
6031 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6032 if (event.xclient.message_type
6033 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6034 {
6035 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6036 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6037 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6038
6039 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6040 goto done;
6041 }
6042
6043 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6044
6045 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6046 if (!f)
6047 goto OTHER;
6048 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6049 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6050 }
6051 break;
6052
6053 case SelectionNotify:
6054 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6055 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6056 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6057 goto OTHER;
6058 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6059 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6060 break;
6061
6062 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6063 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6064 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6065 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6066 goto OTHER;
6067 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6068 {
6069 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6070
6071 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6072 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6073 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6074 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6075 }
6076 break;
6077
6078 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6079 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6080 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6081 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6082 goto OTHER;
6083 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6084 {
6085 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6086
6087 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6088 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6089 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6090 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6091 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6092 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6093 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6094 }
6095 break;
6096
6097 case PropertyNotify:
6098 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6099 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6100 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6101 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty) && f->iconified
6102 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6103 {
6104 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed. It hides
6105 the frame. So if our state says we aren't hidden anymore,
6106 treat it as deiconified. */
6107 if (! f->async_iconified)
6108 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6109 f->async_visible = 1;
6110 f->async_iconified = 0;
6111 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6112 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6113 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6114 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6115 }
6116
6117 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6118 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6119 goto OTHER;
6120
6121 case ReparentNotify:
6122 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6123 if (f)
6124 {
6125 int x, y;
6126 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6127 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6128 f->left_pos = x;
6129 f->top_pos = y;
6130
6131 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6132 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6133 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6134
6135 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6136 }
6137 goto OTHER;
6138
6139 case Expose:
6140 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6141 if (f)
6142 {
6143 #ifdef USE_GTK
6144 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6145 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6146 event.xexpose.window,
6147 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6148 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6149 FALSE);
6150 #endif
6151 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6152 {
6153 f->async_visible = 1;
6154 f->async_iconified = 0;
6155 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6156 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6157 }
6158 else
6159 expose_frame (f,
6160 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6161 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6162 }
6163 else
6164 {
6165 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6166 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6167 #endif
6168 #if defined USE_LUCID
6169 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6170 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6171 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6172 {
6173 Widget widget
6174 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6175 if (widget)
6176 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6177 }
6178 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6179
6180 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6181 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6182 goto OTHER;
6183 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6184 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6185 event.xexpose.window);
6186
6187 if (bar)
6188 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6189 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6190 else
6191 goto OTHER;
6192 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6193 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6194 }
6195 break;
6196
6197 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6198 source area was obscured or not
6199 available. */
6200 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6201 if (f)
6202 {
6203 expose_frame (f,
6204 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6205 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6206 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6207 }
6208 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6209 else
6210 goto OTHER;
6211 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6212 break;
6213
6214 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6215 source area was completely
6216 available. */
6217 break;
6218
6219 case UnmapNotify:
6220 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6221 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6222 {
6223 tip_window = 0;
6224 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6225 }
6226
6227 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6228 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6229 the frame was deleted. */
6230 {
6231 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6232 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6233 display that won't ever be seen. */
6234 f->async_visible = 0;
6235 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6236 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6237 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6238 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6239 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6240 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6241 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6242 {
6243 f->async_iconified = 1;
6244
6245 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6246 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6247 }
6248 }
6249 goto OTHER;
6250
6251 case MapNotify:
6252 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6253 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6254 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6255 goto OTHER;
6256
6257 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6258 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6259 frame is visible. */
6260 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6261 if (f)
6262 {
6263 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6264 the frame's display structures.
6265 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6266 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6267 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6268 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6269 if (! f->async_iconified)
6270 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6271
6272 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6273 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6274 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6275 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6276
6277 f->async_visible = 1;
6278 f->async_iconified = 0;
6279 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6280
6281 if (f->iconified)
6282 {
6283 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6284 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6285 }
6286 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6287 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6288 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6289 to update the frame titles
6290 in case this is the second frame. */
6291 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6292
6293 #ifdef USE_GTK
6294 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6295 #endif
6296 }
6297 goto OTHER;
6298
6299 case KeyPress:
6300
6301 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6302 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6303
6304 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6305 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6306 if (popup_activated ())
6307 goto OTHER;
6308 #endif
6309
6310 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6311
6312 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6313 mouse highlighting. */
6314 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6315 && (f == 0
6316 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6317 {
6318 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6319 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6320 }
6321
6322 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6323 if (f == 0)
6324 {
6325 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6326 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6327 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6328 event.xkey.window);
6329 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6330 {
6331 widget = XtParent (widget);
6332 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6333 }
6334 }
6335 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6336
6337 if (f != 0)
6338 {
6339 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6340 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6341 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6342 his Emacs hang.
6343
6344 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6345 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6346 status_return even if the input is too long to
6347 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6348 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6349 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6350 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6351 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6352 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6353 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6354 int modifiers;
6355 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6356 Lisp_Object c;
6357
6358 #ifdef USE_GTK
6359 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6360 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6361 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6362 (see above). */
6363 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6364 #endif
6365
6366 event.xkey.state
6367 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6368 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6369 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6370
6371 /* This will have to go some day... */
6372
6373 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6374 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6375 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6376 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6377 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6378 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6379 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6380
6381 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6382 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6383 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6384 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6385 not it is combined with Meta. */
6386 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6387 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6388
6389 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6390 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6391 {
6392 Status status_return;
6393
6394 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6395 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6396 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6397 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6398 &status_return);
6399 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6400 {
6401 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6402 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6403 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6404 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6405 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6406 &status_return);
6407 }
6408 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6409 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6410 break;
6411 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6412 {
6413 keysym = NoSymbol;
6414 modifiers = 0;
6415 }
6416 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6417 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6418 emacs_abort ();
6419 }
6420 else
6421 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6422 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6423 &compose_status);
6424 #else
6425 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6426 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6427 &compose_status);
6428 #endif
6429
6430 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6431 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6432 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6433 break;
6434
6435 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6436 orig_keysym = keysym;
6437
6438 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6439 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6440 inev.ie.modifiers
6441 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6442 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6443
6444 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6445 translations to characters. */
6446 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6447 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6448 {
6449 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6450 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6451 goto done_keysym;
6452 }
6453
6454 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6455 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6456 {
6457 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6458 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6459 else
6460 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6461 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6462 goto done_keysym;
6463 }
6464
6465 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6466 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6467 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6468 Vx_keysym_table,
6469 Qnil),
6470 NATNUMP (c)))
6471 {
6472 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6473 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6474 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6475 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6476 goto done_keysym;
6477 }
6478
6479 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6480 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6481 || keysym == XK_Delete
6482 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6483 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6484 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6485 #endif
6486 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6487 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6488 #ifdef HPUX
6489 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6490 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6491 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6492 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6493 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6494 #endif
6495 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6496 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6497 #endif
6498 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6499 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6500 #endif
6501 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6502 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6503 #endif
6504 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6505 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6506 #endif
6507 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6508 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6509 #endif
6510 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6511 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6512 #endif
6513 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6514 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6515 #endif
6516 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6517 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6518 #endif
6519 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6520 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6521 #endif
6522 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6523 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6524 #endif
6525 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6526 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6527 #endif
6528 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6529 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6530 #endif
6531 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6532 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6533 #endif
6534 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6535 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6536 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6537 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6538 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6539 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6540 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6541 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6542 don't have real modifiers but
6543 should be treated similarly to
6544 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6545 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6546 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6547 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6548 #endif
6549 ))
6550 {
6551 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6552 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6553 key. */
6554 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6555 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6556 goto done_keysym;
6557 }
6558
6559 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6560 ptrdiff_t i;
6561 int nchars, len;
6562
6563 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6564 {
6565 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6566 nchars++;
6567 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6568 }
6569
6570 if (nchars < nbytes)
6571 {
6572 /* Decode the input data. */
6573
6574 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6575 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6576 we used just above and the locale. */
6577 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6578 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6579 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6580 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6581 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6582 gives us composition information. */
6583 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6584
6585 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6586 nbytes);
6587 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6588 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6589 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6590 nbytes = coding.produced;
6591 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6592 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6593 }
6594
6595 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6596 character events. */
6597 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6598 {
6599 int ch;
6600 if (nchars == nbytes)
6601 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6602 else
6603 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6604 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6605 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6606 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6607 inev.ie.code = ch;
6608 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6609 }
6610
6611 count += nchars;
6612
6613 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6614
6615 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6616 break;
6617 }
6618 }
6619 done_keysym:
6620 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6621 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6622 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6623 client. */
6624 break;
6625 #else
6626 goto OTHER;
6627 #endif
6628
6629 case KeyRelease:
6630 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6631 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6632 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6633 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6634 client. */
6635 break;
6636 #else
6637 goto OTHER;
6638 #endif
6639
6640 case EnterNotify:
6641 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6642 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6643
6644 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6645
6646 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6647 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6648
6649 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6650 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6651 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6652 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6653 #ifdef USE_GTK
6654 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6655 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6656 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6657 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6658 #endif
6659 goto OTHER;
6660
6661 case FocusIn:
6662 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6663 goto OTHER;
6664
6665 case LeaveNotify:
6666 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6667 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6668
6669 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6670 if (f)
6671 {
6672 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6673 {
6674 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6675 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6676 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6677 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6678 }
6679
6680 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6681 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6682 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6683 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6684 if (any_help_event_p)
6685 do_help = -1;
6686 }
6687 #ifdef USE_GTK
6688 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6689 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6690 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6691 #endif
6692 goto OTHER;
6693
6694 case FocusOut:
6695 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6696 goto OTHER;
6697
6698 case MotionNotify:
6699 {
6700 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6701 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6702 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6703
6704 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6705 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6706 f = last_mouse_frame;
6707 else
6708 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6709
6710 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6711 {
6712 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6713 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6714 }
6715
6716 #ifdef USE_GTK
6717 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6718 f = 0;
6719 #endif
6720 if (f)
6721 {
6722
6723 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6724 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6725 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6726 {
6727 Lisp_Object window;
6728
6729 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6730 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6731 0, 0);
6732
6733 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6734 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6735 will be selected only when it is active. */
6736 if (WINDOWP (window)
6737 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6738 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6739 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6740 create event iff we don't leave the
6741 selected frame. */
6742 && (focus_follows_mouse
6743 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6744 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6745 {
6746 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6747 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6748 }
6749
6750 last_window=window;
6751 }
6752 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6753 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6754 }
6755 else
6756 {
6757 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6758 struct scroll_bar *bar
6759 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6760 event.xmotion.window);
6761
6762 if (bar)
6763 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6764 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6765
6766 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6767 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6768 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6769 }
6770
6771 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6772 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6773 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6774 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6775 do_help = 1;
6776 goto OTHER;
6777 }
6778
6779 case ConfigureNotify:
6780 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6781 #ifdef USE_GTK
6782 if (!f
6783 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6784 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6785 {
6786 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6787 event.xconfigure.height);
6788 f = 0;
6789 }
6790 #endif
6791 if (f)
6792 {
6793 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6794 #ifndef USE_GTK
6795 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6796 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6797
6798 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6799 is called by the code that handles resizing
6800 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6801
6802 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6803 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6804 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6805 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6806 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6807 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6808 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6809 {
6810 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6811 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6812 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6813 }
6814
6815 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6816 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6817 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6818 #endif
6819
6820 #ifdef USE_GTK
6821 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6822 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6823 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6824 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6825 #endif
6826 {
6827 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6828 }
6829
6830 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6831 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6832 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6833 #endif
6834
6835 }
6836 goto OTHER;
6837
6838 case ButtonRelease:
6839 case ButtonPress:
6840 {
6841 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6842 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6843 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6844
6845 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6846 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6847 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6848
6849 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6850 && last_mouse_frame
6851 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6852 f = last_mouse_frame;
6853 else
6854 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6855
6856 #ifdef USE_GTK
6857 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6858 f = 0;
6859 #endif
6860 if (f)
6861 {
6862 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6863 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6864 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6865 {
6866 Lisp_Object window;
6867 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6868 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6869
6870 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6871 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6872
6873 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6874 {
6875 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6876 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6877 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6878 event.xbutton.state));
6879 }
6880 }
6881
6882 if (!tool_bar_p)
6883 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6884 if (! popup_activated ())
6885 #endif
6886 {
6887 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6888 {
6889 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6890 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6891 {
6892 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6893 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6894 }
6895 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6896 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6897 }
6898 else
6899 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6900 }
6901 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6902 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6903 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6904 }
6905 else
6906 {
6907 struct scroll_bar *bar
6908 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6909 event.xbutton.window);
6910
6911 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6912 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6913 scroll bars. */
6914 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6915 {
6916 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6917 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6918 }
6919 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6920 if (bar)
6921 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6922 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6923 }
6924
6925 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6926 {
6927 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6928 last_mouse_frame = f;
6929
6930 if (!tool_bar_p)
6931 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6932 }
6933 else
6934 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6935
6936 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6937 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6938 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6939 if (f != 0)
6940 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6941
6942 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6943 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6944 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6945 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6946 Instead, save it away
6947 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6948 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6949 if (! popup_activated ()
6950 #ifdef USE_GTK
6951 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6952 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6953 #endif
6954 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6955 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6956 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6957 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6958 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6959 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6960 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6961 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6962 {
6963 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6964 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6965 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6966 }
6967 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6968 {
6969 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6970 goto OTHER;
6971 }
6972 else
6973 goto OTHER;
6974 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6975 }
6976 break;
6977
6978 case CirculateNotify:
6979 goto OTHER;
6980
6981 case CirculateRequest:
6982 goto OTHER;
6983
6984 case VisibilityNotify:
6985 goto OTHER;
6986
6987 case MappingNotify:
6988 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6989 local cache. */
6990 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6991 {
6992 case MappingModifier:
6993 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6994 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6995 case MappingKeyboard:
6996 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6997 }
6998 goto OTHER;
6999
7000 case DestroyNotify:
7001 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7002 break;
7003
7004 default:
7005 OTHER:
7006 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7007 block_input ();
7008 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7009 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7010 unblock_input ();
7011 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7012 break;
7013 }
7014
7015 done:
7016 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7017 {
7018 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7019 count++;
7020 }
7021
7022 if (do_help
7023 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7024 {
7025 Lisp_Object frame;
7026
7027 if (f)
7028 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7029 else
7030 frame = Qnil;
7031
7032 if (do_help > 0)
7033 {
7034 any_help_event_p = 1;
7035 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7036 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7037 }
7038 else
7039 {
7040 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7041 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7042 }
7043 count++;
7044 }
7045
7046 SAFE_FREE ();
7047 *eventptr = event;
7048 return count;
7049 }
7050
7051 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7052
7053 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7054 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7055 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7056
7057 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7058 int
7059 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7060 {
7061 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7062 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7063
7064 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7065
7066 if (dpyinfo)
7067 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7068
7069 return finish;
7070 }
7071 #endif
7072
7073
7074 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7075 Return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7076
7077 Return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7078 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7079 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7080 C chars). */
7081
7082 static int
7083 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7084 {
7085 int count = 0;
7086 int event_found = 0;
7087
7088 block_input ();
7089
7090 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7091 input_signal_count++;
7092
7093 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7094 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7095 {
7096 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7097 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7098 }
7099
7100 #ifndef USE_GTK
7101 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7102 {
7103 int finish;
7104 XEvent event;
7105
7106 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7107
7108 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7109 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7110 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7111 continue;
7112 #endif
7113 event_found = 1;
7114
7115 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7116 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7117
7118 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7119 goto out;
7120 }
7121
7122 out:;
7123
7124 #else /* USE_GTK */
7125
7126 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7127 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7128 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7129 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7130
7131 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7132 from all displays. */
7133
7134 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7135 {
7136 current_count = count;
7137 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7138
7139 gtk_main_iteration ();
7140
7141 count = current_count;
7142 current_count = -1;
7143 current_hold_quit = 0;
7144
7145 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7146 break;
7147 }
7148 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7149
7150 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7151 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7152 if (! event_found)
7153 {
7154 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7155 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7156 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7157 x_noop_count++;
7158 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7159 {
7160 x_noop_count=0;
7161
7162 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7163 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7164
7165 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7166
7167 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7168 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7169 }
7170 }
7171
7172 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7173 raise it now. */
7174 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7175 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7176 {
7177 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7178 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7179 }
7180
7181 unblock_input ();
7182
7183 return count;
7184 }
7185
7186
7187
7188 \f
7189 /***********************************************************************
7190 Text Cursor
7191 ***********************************************************************/
7192
7193 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7194 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7195
7196 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7197 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7198 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7199
7200 static void
7201 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7202 {
7203 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7204 XRectangle clip_rect;
7205 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7206
7207 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7208
7209 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7210 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7211 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7212 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7213 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7214
7215 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7216 }
7217
7218
7219 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7220
7221 static void
7222 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7223 {
7224 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7225 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7226 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7227 int x, y, wd, h;
7228 XGCValues xgcv;
7229 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7230 GC gc;
7231
7232 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7233 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7234 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7235 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7236 return;
7237
7238 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7239 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7240 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7241
7242 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7243 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7244 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7245 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7246 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7247 else
7248 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7249 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7250 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7251
7252 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7253 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7254 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7255 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7256 }
7257
7258
7259 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7260
7261 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7262 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7263 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7264 --gerd. */
7265
7266 static void
7267 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7268 {
7269 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7270 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7271
7272 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7273 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7274 and mini-buffer. */
7275 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7276 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7277 return;
7278
7279 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7280 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7281 the bar might not be in the window. */
7282 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7283 {
7284 struct glyph_row *r;
7285 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7286 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7287 }
7288 else
7289 {
7290 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7291 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7292 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7293 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7294 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7295 XGCValues xgcv;
7296
7297 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7298 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7299 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7300 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7301 that the glyph is legible. */
7302 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7303 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7304 else
7305 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7306 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7307
7308 if (gc)
7309 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7310 else
7311 {
7312 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7313 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7314 }
7315
7316 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7317
7318 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7319 {
7320 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7321
7322 if (width < 0)
7323 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7324 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7325
7326 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7327
7328 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7329 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7330 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7331 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7332
7333 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7334 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7335 width, row->height);
7336 }
7337 else
7338 {
7339 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7340
7341 if (width < 0)
7342 width = row->height;
7343
7344 width = min (row->height, width);
7345
7346 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7347 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7348
7349 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7350 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7351 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7352 row->height - width),
7353 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7354 }
7355
7356 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7357 }
7358 }
7359
7360
7361 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7362
7363 static void
7364 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7365 {
7366 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7367 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7368 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7369 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7370 }
7371
7372
7373 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7374
7375 static void
7376 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7377 {
7378 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7379 x, y, width, height, False);
7380 #ifdef USE_GTK
7381 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7382 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7383 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7384 #endif
7385 }
7386
7387
7388 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7389
7390 static void
7391 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7392 {
7393 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7394
7395 if (on_p)
7396 {
7397 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7398 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7399
7400 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7401 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7402 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7403 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7404 {
7405 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7406 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7407 }
7408 else
7409 {
7410 switch (cursor_type)
7411 {
7412 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7413 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7414 break;
7415
7416 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7417 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7418 break;
7419
7420 case BAR_CURSOR:
7421 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7422 break;
7423
7424 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7425 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7426 break;
7427
7428 case NO_CURSOR:
7429 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7430 break;
7431
7432 default:
7433 emacs_abort ();
7434 }
7435 }
7436
7437 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7438 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7439 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7440 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7441 #endif
7442 }
7443
7444 #ifndef XFlush
7445 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7446 #endif
7447 }
7448
7449 \f
7450 /* Icons. */
7451
7452 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7453
7454 int
7455 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7456 {
7457 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7458
7459 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7460 return 1;
7461
7462 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7463 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7464 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7465 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7466
7467 if (STRINGP (file))
7468 {
7469 #ifdef USE_GTK
7470 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7471 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7472 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7473 return 0;
7474 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7475 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7476 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7477 }
7478 else
7479 {
7480 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7481 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7482 {
7483 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7484
7485 #ifdef USE_GTK
7486
7487 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7488 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7489 return 0;
7490
7491 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7492
7493 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7494 if (rc != -1)
7495 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7496
7497 #endif
7498
7499 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7500 if (rc == -1)
7501 {
7502 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7503 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7504 if (rc == -1)
7505 return 1;
7506
7507 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7508 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7509 }
7510 }
7511
7512 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7513 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7514 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7515 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7516 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7517
7518 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7519 }
7520
7521 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7522 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7523
7524 return 0;
7525 }
7526
7527
7528 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7529 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7530
7531 int
7532 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7533 {
7534 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7535 return 1;
7536
7537 {
7538 XTextProperty text;
7539 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7540 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7541 text.format = 8;
7542 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7543 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7544 }
7545
7546 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7547 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7548 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7549 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7550
7551 return 0;
7552 }
7553 \f
7554 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7555
7556 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7557 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7558
7559 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7560 be called from a signal handler.
7561 */
7562
7563 struct x_error_message_stack {
7564 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7565 Display *dpy;
7566 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7567 };
7568 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7569
7570 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7571 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7572 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7573
7574 static void
7575 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7576 {
7577 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7578 x_error_message->string,
7579 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7580 }
7581
7582 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7583 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7584 operating on.
7585
7586 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7587 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7588 stored in *x_error_message.
7589
7590 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7591 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7592
7593 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7594
7595 void
7596 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7597 {
7598 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
7599
7600 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7601 XSync (dpy, False);
7602
7603 data->dpy = dpy;
7604 data->string[0] = 0;
7605 data->prev = x_error_message;
7606 x_error_message = data;
7607 }
7608
7609 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7610 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7611
7612 void
7613 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7614 {
7615 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7616
7617 block_input ();
7618
7619 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7620 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7621 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7622 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7623
7624 tmp = x_error_message;
7625 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7626 xfree (tmp);
7627 unblock_input ();
7628 }
7629
7630 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7631 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7632 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7633
7634 void
7635 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7636 {
7637 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7638 XSync (dpy, False);
7639
7640 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7641 {
7642 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7643 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7644 x_uncatch_errors ();
7645 error (format, string);
7646 }
7647 }
7648
7649 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7650 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7651
7652 int
7653 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7654 {
7655 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7656 XSync (dpy, False);
7657
7658 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7659 }
7660
7661 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7662
7663 void
7664 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7665 {
7666 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7667 }
7668
7669 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7670 * idea. --lorentey */
7671 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7672
7673 void
7674 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7675 {
7676 while (x_error_message)
7677 x_uncatch_errors ();
7678 }
7679 #endif
7680
7681 #if 0
7682 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7683 x_trace_wire (void)
7684 {
7685 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7686 }
7687 #endif /* ! 0 */
7688
7689 \f
7690 /************************************************************************
7691 Handling X errors
7692 ************************************************************************/
7693
7694 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7695
7696 static char *error_msg;
7697
7698 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7699 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7700
7701 static void
7702 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7703 {
7704 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7705 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7706 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7707
7708 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7709 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7710
7711 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7712 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7713
7714 if (dpyinfo)
7715 {
7716 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7717 frame on it. */
7718 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7719 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7720 }
7721
7722 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7723 that are on the dead display. */
7724 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7725 {
7726 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7727 minibuf_frame
7728 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7729 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7730 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7731 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7732 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7733 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7734 }
7735
7736 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7737 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7738 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7739 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7740 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7741 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7742 {
7743 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7744 trying to find a replacement. */
7745 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Qt);
7746 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7747 }
7748
7749 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7750 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7751 if (dpyinfo)
7752 {
7753 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7754 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7755 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7756 #ifdef USE_GTK
7757 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7758 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7759 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7760 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7761 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil);
7762 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7763 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7764 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7765 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7766 error_msg);
7767 emacs_abort ();
7768 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7769
7770 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7771 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7772
7773 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7774 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7775 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7776 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7777 emacs_abort ();
7778
7779 {
7780 Lisp_Object tmp;
7781 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7782 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7783 }
7784 }
7785
7786 if (terminal_list == 0)
7787 {
7788 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7789 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7790 /* NOTREACHED */
7791 }
7792
7793 totally_unblock_input ();
7794
7795 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7796 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7797
7798 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7799 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7800
7801 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7802 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7803 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7804 error ("%s", error_msg);
7805 }
7806
7807 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7808 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7809 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7810
7811 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7812 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7813
7814 static int
7815 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7816 {
7817 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
7818 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7819 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7820 && event->minor_code == 0)
7821 {
7822 return 0;
7823 }
7824 #endif
7825
7826 if (x_error_message)
7827 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7828 else
7829 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7830 return 0;
7831 }
7832
7833 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7834 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7835 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7836
7837 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7838
7839 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7840 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7841
7842 static void NO_INLINE
7843 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7844 {
7845 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7846
7847 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7848 or colors that are not defined. */
7849
7850 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7851 return;
7852
7853 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7854 original error handler. */
7855
7856 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7857 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7858 buf, event->request_code);
7859 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7860 }
7861
7862
7863 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7864 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7865 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7866
7867 static int
7868 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7869 {
7870 char buf[256];
7871
7872 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7873 DisplayString (display));
7874 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7875 return 0;
7876 }
7877 \f
7878 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7879
7880 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7881 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7882 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7883 FONT-OBJECT. */
7884
7885 Lisp_Object
7886 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7887 {
7888 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7889
7890 if (fontset < 0)
7891 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7892 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7893 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7894 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7895 do. */
7896 return font_object;
7897
7898 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7899 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7900 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7901 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7902
7903 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7904
7905 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7906 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7907 {
7908 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7909 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7910 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7911 }
7912 else
7913 {
7914 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7915 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7916 }
7917
7918 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7919 {
7920 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7921 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7922 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7923 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7924 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7925 }
7926
7927 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7928 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7929 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7930 {
7931 block_input ();
7932 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7933 unblock_input ();
7934 }
7935 #endif
7936
7937 return font_object;
7938 }
7939
7940 \f
7941 /***********************************************************************
7942 X Input Methods
7943 ***********************************************************************/
7944
7945 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7946
7947 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7948
7949 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7950 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7951 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7952
7953 static void
7954 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7955 {
7956 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7957 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7958
7959 block_input ();
7960
7961 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7962 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7963 {
7964 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7965 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7966 {
7967 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7968 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7969 }
7970 }
7971
7972 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7973 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7974 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7975 unblock_input ();
7976 }
7977
7978 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7979
7980 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7981 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7982 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
7983 #endif
7984
7985 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7986 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7987
7988 static void
7989 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
7990 {
7991 XIM xim;
7992
7993 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7994 if (use_xim)
7995 {
7996 if (dpyinfo->xim)
7997 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
7998 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7999 emacs_class);
8000 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8001
8002 if (xim)
8003 {
8004 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8005 XIMCallback destroy;
8006 #endif
8007
8008 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8009 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8010
8011 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8012 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8013 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8014 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8015 #endif
8016 }
8017 }
8018
8019 else
8020 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8021 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8022 }
8023
8024
8025 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8026
8027 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8028 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8029 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8030 when the callback was registered. */
8031
8032 static void
8033 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8034 {
8035 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8036 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8037
8038 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8039 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8040 return;
8041
8042 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8043
8044 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8045 as they have no XIC. */
8046 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8047 {
8048 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8049
8050 block_input ();
8051 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8052 {
8053 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8054
8055 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8056 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8057 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8058 {
8059 create_frame_xic (f);
8060 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8061 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8062 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8063 {
8064 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8065 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8066 }
8067 }
8068 }
8069
8070 unblock_input ();
8071 }
8072 }
8073
8074 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8075
8076
8077 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8078 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8079 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8080 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8081
8082 static void
8083 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8084 {
8085 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8086 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8087 if (use_xim)
8088 {
8089 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8090 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
8091 ptrdiff_t len;
8092
8093 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8094 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8095 len = strlen (resource_name);
8096 xim_inst->resource_name = xmalloc (len + 1);
8097 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8098 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8099 resource_name, emacs_class,
8100 xim_instantiate_callback,
8101 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8102 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8103 least, hence the configure test. */
8104 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8105 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8106 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8107 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8108 }
8109 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8110 }
8111
8112
8113 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8114
8115 static void
8116 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8117 {
8118 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8119 if (use_xim)
8120 {
8121 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8122 if (dpyinfo->display)
8123 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8124 NULL, emacs_class,
8125 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8126 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8127 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8128 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8129 if (dpyinfo->display)
8130 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8131 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8132 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8133 }
8134 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8135 }
8136
8137 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8138
8139
8140 \f
8141 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8142 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8143
8144 static void
8145 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8146 {
8147 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8148
8149 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8150 is already for the top-left corner. */
8151 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8152 return;
8153
8154 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8155 position that fits on the screen. */
8156 if (flags & XNegative)
8157 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8158 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8159
8160 {
8161 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8162
8163 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8164 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8165 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8166
8167 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8168 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8169 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8170 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8171 is right, though.
8172
8173 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8174 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8175
8176 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8177 #endif
8178
8179 if (flags & YNegative)
8180 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8181 - height + f->top_pos;
8182 }
8183
8184 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8185 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8186 so the flags should correspond. */
8187 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8188 }
8189
8190 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8191 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8192 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8193 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8194 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8195
8196 void
8197 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8198 {
8199 int modified_top, modified_left;
8200
8201 if (change_gravity > 0)
8202 {
8203 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8204 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8205
8206 f->top_pos = yoff;
8207 f->left_pos = xoff;
8208 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8209 if (xoff < 0)
8210 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8211 if (yoff < 0)
8212 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8213 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8214 }
8215 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8216
8217 block_input ();
8218 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8219
8220 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8221 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8222
8223 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8224 {
8225 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8226 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8227 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8228 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8229 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8230 }
8231
8232 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8233 modified_left, modified_top);
8234
8235 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8236 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8237 ? 1 : 0);
8238
8239 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8240 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8241 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8242 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8243 of the frame.
8244
8245 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8246 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8247 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8248
8249 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8250 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8251 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8252 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8253 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8254 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8255
8256 unblock_input ();
8257 }
8258
8259 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8260 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8261 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8262 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8263 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8264
8265 static int
8266 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8267 {
8268 Atom actual_type;
8269 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8270 int i, rc, actual_format;
8271 Window wmcheck_window;
8272 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8273 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8274 long max_len = 65536;
8275 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8276 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8277 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8278
8279 block_input ();
8280
8281 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8282 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8283 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8284 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8285 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8286 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8287
8288 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8289 {
8290 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8291 x_uncatch_errors ();
8292 unblock_input ();
8293 return 0;
8294 }
8295
8296 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8297 XFree (tmp_data);
8298
8299 /* Check if window exists. */
8300 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8301 x_sync (f);
8302 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8303 {
8304 x_uncatch_errors ();
8305 unblock_input ();
8306 return 0;
8307 }
8308
8309 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8310 {
8311 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8312 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8313 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8314 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8315 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8316 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8317
8318 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8319 tmp_data = NULL;
8320 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8321 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8322 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8323 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8324 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8325
8326 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8327 {
8328 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8329 x_uncatch_errors ();
8330 unblock_input ();
8331 return 0;
8332 }
8333
8334 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8335 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8336 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8337 }
8338
8339 rc = 0;
8340
8341 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8342 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8343
8344 x_uncatch_errors ();
8345 unblock_input ();
8346
8347 return rc;
8348 }
8349
8350 static void
8351 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8352 {
8353 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8354
8355 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8356 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8357 make_number (32),
8358 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8359 Fcons
8360 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8361 Fcons
8362 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8363 value != 0
8364 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8365 : Qnil)));
8366 }
8367
8368 void
8369 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8370 {
8371 Lisp_Object frame;
8372 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8373
8374 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8375
8376 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8377 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8378 }
8379
8380 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8381 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8382 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8383
8384 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8385
8386 static int
8387 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8388 Window window,
8389 int *size_state,
8390 int *sticky)
8391 {
8392 Atom actual_type;
8393 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8394 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8395 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8396 long max_len = 65536;
8397 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8398 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8399 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8400
8401 *sticky = 0;
8402 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8403
8404 block_input ();
8405 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8406 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8407 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8408 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8409 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8410
8411 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8412 {
8413 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8414 x_uncatch_errors ();
8415 unblock_input ();
8416 return ! f->iconified;
8417 }
8418
8419 x_uncatch_errors ();
8420
8421 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8422 {
8423 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8424 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8425 {
8426 is_hidden = 1;
8427 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8428 }
8429 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8430 {
8431 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8432 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8433 else
8434 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8435 }
8436 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8437 {
8438 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8439 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8440 else
8441 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8442 }
8443 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8444 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8445 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8446 *sticky = 1;
8447 }
8448
8449 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8450 unblock_input ();
8451 return ! is_hidden;
8452 }
8453
8454 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8455
8456 static int
8457 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8458 {
8459 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8460 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8461 int cur, dummy;
8462
8463 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8464
8465 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8466 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8467 if (!have_net_atom)
8468 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8469
8470 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8471 {
8472 Lisp_Object frame;
8473
8474 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8475
8476 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8477 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8478 are sent at once. */
8479 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8480 {
8481 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8482 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8483 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8484 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8485 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8486 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8487 break;
8488 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8489 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8490 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8491 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8492 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8493 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8494 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8495 break;
8496 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8497 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8498 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8499 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8500 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8501 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8502 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8503 break;
8504 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8505 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8506 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8507 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8508 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8509 break;
8510 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8511 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8512 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8513 else
8514 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8515 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8516 }
8517
8518 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8519
8520 }
8521
8522 return have_net_atom;
8523 }
8524
8525 static void
8526 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8527 {
8528 if (f->async_visible)
8529 {
8530 block_input ();
8531 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8532 x_sync (f);
8533 unblock_input ();
8534 }
8535 }
8536
8537
8538 static int
8539 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8540 {
8541 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8542 Lisp_Object lval;
8543 int sticky = 0;
8544 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8545
8546 lval = Qnil;
8547 switch (value)
8548 {
8549 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8550 lval = Qfullwidth;
8551 break;
8552 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8553 lval = Qfullheight;
8554 break;
8555 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8556 lval = Qfullboth;
8557 break;
8558 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8559 lval = Qmaximized;
8560 break;
8561 }
8562
8563 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8564 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8565
8566 return not_hidden;
8567 }
8568
8569 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8570 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8571 static void
8572 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8573 {
8574 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8575 return;
8576
8577 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8578 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8579
8580 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8581 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8582 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8583
8584 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8585 {
8586 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8587 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8588
8589 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8590 {
8591 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8592 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8593 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8594 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8595 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8596 break;
8597 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8598 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8599 break;
8600 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8601 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8602 }
8603
8604 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8605 width, height);
8606 }
8607 }
8608
8609 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8610 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8611 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8612 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8613 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8614 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8615 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8616
8617 static void
8618 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8619 {
8620 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8621
8622 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8623 window manager window around the frame. */
8624
8625 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8626
8627 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8628 {
8629 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8630
8631 int adjusted_left;
8632 int adjusted_top;
8633
8634 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8635 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8636 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8637
8638 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8639
8640 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8641 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8642
8643 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8644 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8645
8646 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8647 }
8648 else
8649 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8650 frame's position. */
8651
8652 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8653 }
8654
8655
8656 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8657 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8658 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8659 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8660 of an exact comparison. */
8661
8662 static void
8663 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8664 {
8665 int count = 0;
8666
8667 while (count++ < 50)
8668 {
8669 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8670
8671 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8672 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8673 loop. */
8674
8675 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8676 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8677
8678 if (fuzzy)
8679 {
8680 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8681 pixels. */
8682
8683 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8684 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8685 return;
8686 }
8687 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8688 return;
8689 }
8690
8691 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8692 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8693
8694 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8695 }
8696
8697
8698 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8699 void
8700 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8701 {
8702 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8703
8704 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8705 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8706 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8707
8708 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8709 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8710
8711 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8712 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8713 tmo = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
8714 tmo_at = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), tmo);
8715
8716 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8717 {
8718 pending_signals = 1;
8719 totally_unblock_input ();
8720 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8721 block_input ();
8722 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8723
8724 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8725 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8726
8727 time_now = current_emacs_time ();
8728 if (EMACS_TIME_LT (tmo_at, time_now))
8729 break;
8730
8731 tmo = sub_emacs_time (tmo_at, time_now);
8732 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
8733 break; /* Timeout */
8734 }
8735 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8736 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8737 }
8738
8739
8740 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8741 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8742 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8743 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8744
8745 static void
8746 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8747 {
8748 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8749
8750 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8751 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8752 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8753 ? 0
8754 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8755
8756 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8757
8758 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8759 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8760 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8761 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8762
8763 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8764 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8765 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8766 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8767
8768
8769 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8770 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8771 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8772 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8773 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8774
8775 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8776 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8777 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8778 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8779
8780 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8781 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8782 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8783 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8784 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8785
8786 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8787 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8788
8789 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8790 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8791 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8792 if (f->async_visible)
8793 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8794 else
8795 {
8796 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8797 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8798 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8799 x_sync (f);
8800 }
8801 }
8802
8803
8804 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8805 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8806 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8807 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8808
8809 void
8810 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8811 {
8812 block_input ();
8813
8814 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8815 {
8816 int r, c;
8817
8818 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8819 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8820 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8821 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8822 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8823 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8824 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8825 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8826 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8827 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8828 is however. */
8829 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8830 #endif
8831 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8832 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8833 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8834 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8835 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8836 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8837 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8838 }
8839
8840 #ifdef USE_GTK
8841 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8842 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8843 else
8844 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8845 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8846
8847 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8848
8849 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8850
8851 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8852 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8853
8854 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8855 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8856 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8857 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8858 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8859
8860 unblock_input ();
8861 }
8862 \f
8863 /* Mouse warping. */
8864
8865 void
8866 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8867 {
8868 int pix_x, pix_y;
8869
8870 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8871 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8872
8873 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8874 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8875
8876 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8877 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8878
8879 block_input ();
8880
8881 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8882 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8883 unblock_input ();
8884 }
8885
8886 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8887
8888 void
8889 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8890 {
8891 block_input ();
8892
8893 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8894 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8895 unblock_input ();
8896 }
8897 \f
8898 /* Raise frame F. */
8899
8900 void
8901 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8902 {
8903 block_input ();
8904 if (f->async_visible)
8905 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8906
8907 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8908 unblock_input ();
8909 }
8910
8911 /* Lower frame F. */
8912
8913 static void
8914 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8915 {
8916 if (f->async_visible)
8917 {
8918 block_input ();
8919 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8920 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8921 unblock_input ();
8922 }
8923 }
8924
8925 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
8926
8927 void
8928 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
8929 {
8930 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
8931 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
8932 if (f->async_visible)
8933 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
8934 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
8935 }
8936
8937 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8938
8939 void
8940 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8941 {
8942 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8943 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8944
8945 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8946 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8947 {
8948 Lisp_Object frame;
8949 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8950 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8951 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8952 make_number (32),
8953 Fcons (make_number (1),
8954 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8955 Qnil)));
8956 }
8957 }
8958
8959 static void
8960 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8961 {
8962 if (raise_flag)
8963 x_raise_frame (f);
8964 else
8965 x_lower_frame (f);
8966 }
8967 \f
8968 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8969
8970 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
8971
8972 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8973
8974 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
8975
8976 static void
8977 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8978 {
8979 unsigned long data[2];
8980 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8981
8982 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8983 data[1] = flags;
8984
8985 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8986 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
8987 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
8988 }
8989 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
8990
8991 static void
8992 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
8993 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
8994 {
8995 XEvent event;
8996
8997 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8998 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
8999 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9000 event.xclient.format = 32;
9001 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9002 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9003 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9004 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9005 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9006
9007 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9008 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9009 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9010 }
9011 \f
9012 /* Change of visibility. */
9013
9014 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9015 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9016 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9017 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9018 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9019 finishes with it. */
9020
9021 void
9022 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9023 {
9024 Lisp_Object type;
9025 int original_top, original_left;
9026 int retry_count = 2;
9027
9028 retry:
9029
9030 block_input ();
9031
9032 type = x_icon_type (f);
9033 if (!NILP (type))
9034 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9035
9036 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9037 {
9038 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9039 call x_set_offset a second time
9040 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9041 before the window gets really visible. */
9042 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9043 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9044 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9045 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9046
9047 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9048
9049 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9050 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9051 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9052 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9053 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9054 else
9055 {
9056 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9057 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9058 }
9059 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9060 #ifdef USE_GTK
9061 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9062 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9063 #else
9064 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9065 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9066 else
9067 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9068 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9069 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9070 }
9071
9072 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9073
9074 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9075 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9076 so that incoming events are handled. */
9077 {
9078 Lisp_Object frame;
9079 int count;
9080 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9081 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9082 will set it when they are handled. */
9083 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9084
9085 original_left = f->left_pos;
9086 original_top = f->top_pos;
9087
9088 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9089 unblock_input ();
9090
9091 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9092
9093 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9094 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9095 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9096 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9097
9098 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9099 because the window manager may choose the position
9100 and we don't want to override it. */
9101
9102 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9103 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9104 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9105 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9106 && previously_visible)
9107 {
9108 Drawable rootw;
9109 int x, y;
9110 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9111
9112 block_input ();
9113
9114 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9115 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9116 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9117 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9118 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9119 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9120 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9121 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9122 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9123
9124 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9125 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9126 original_left, original_top);
9127
9128 unblock_input ();
9129 }
9130
9131 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9132
9133 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9134 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9135 MapNotify at all.. */
9136 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9137 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9138 {
9139 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9140 x_sync (f);
9141
9142 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9143 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9144 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9145 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9146 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9147 probably a bug. */
9148 if (input_polling_used ())
9149 {
9150 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9151 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9152 handler reset it. */
9153 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9154 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9155 poll_for_input_1 ();
9156 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9157 }
9158
9159 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9160 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9161 }
9162
9163 /* 2000-09-28: In
9164
9165 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9166 (iconify-frame f)
9167 (raise-frame f))
9168
9169 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9170 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9171 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9172 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9173
9174 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9175 goto retry;
9176 }
9177 }
9178
9179 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9180
9181 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9182
9183 void
9184 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9185 {
9186 Window window;
9187
9188 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9189 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9190
9191 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9192 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9193 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9194
9195 block_input ();
9196
9197 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9198 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9199 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9200 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9201 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9202 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9203
9204 #ifdef USE_GTK
9205 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9206 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9207 else
9208 #else
9209 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9210 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9211 else
9212 #endif
9213 {
9214
9215 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9216 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9217 {
9218 unblock_input ();
9219 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9220 }
9221 }
9222
9223 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9224 just by the event that we get from the server.
9225 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9226 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9227 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9228 f->visible = 0;
9229 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9230 f->async_visible = 0;
9231 f->async_iconified = 0;
9232
9233 x_sync (f);
9234
9235 unblock_input ();
9236 }
9237
9238 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9239
9240 void
9241 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9242 {
9243 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9244 int result;
9245 #endif
9246 Lisp_Object type;
9247
9248 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9249 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9250 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9251
9252 if (f->async_iconified)
9253 return;
9254
9255 block_input ();
9256
9257 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9258
9259 type = x_icon_type (f);
9260 if (!NILP (type))
9261 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9262
9263 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9264 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9265 {
9266 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9267 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9268
9269 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9270 f->iconified = 1;
9271 f->visible = 1;
9272 f->async_iconified = 1;
9273 f->async_visible = 0;
9274 unblock_input ();
9275 return;
9276 }
9277 #endif
9278
9279 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9280
9281 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9282 {
9283 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9284 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9285 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9286 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9287 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9288 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9289 so we have to record it here. */
9290 f->iconified = 1;
9291 f->visible = 1;
9292 f->async_iconified = 1;
9293 f->async_visible = 0;
9294 unblock_input ();
9295 return;
9296 }
9297
9298 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9299 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9300 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9301 unblock_input ();
9302
9303 if (!result)
9304 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9305
9306 f->async_iconified = 1;
9307 f->async_visible = 0;
9308
9309
9310 block_input ();
9311 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9312 unblock_input ();
9313 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9314
9315 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9316 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9317 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9318 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9319 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9320 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9321
9322 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9323 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9324
9325 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9326 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9327 {
9328 XEvent msg;
9329
9330 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9331 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9332 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9333 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9334 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9335
9336 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9337 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9338 False,
9339 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9340 &msg))
9341 {
9342 unblock_input ();
9343 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9344 }
9345 }
9346
9347 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9348 IconicState. */
9349 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9350
9351 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9352 {
9353 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9354 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9355 }
9356
9357 f->async_iconified = 1;
9358 f->async_visible = 0;
9359
9360 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9361 unblock_input ();
9362 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9363 }
9364
9365 \f
9366 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9367
9368 void
9369 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9370 {
9371 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9372 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9373 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9374 Lisp_Object bar;
9375 struct scroll_bar *b;
9376 #endif
9377
9378 block_input ();
9379
9380 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9381 commands to the X server. */
9382 if (dpyinfo->display)
9383 {
9384 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9385 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9386 face. */
9387 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9388 free_frame_faces (f);
9389
9390 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9391 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9392
9393 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9394 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9395 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9396 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9397 toolkit scroll bars. */
9398 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9399 {
9400 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9401 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9402 }
9403 #endif
9404
9405 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9406 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9407 free_frame_xic (f);
9408 #endif
9409
9410 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9411 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9412 {
9413 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9414 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9415 }
9416 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9417 we are using a toolkit. */
9418 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9419 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9420
9421 free_frame_menubar (f);
9422 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9423
9424 #ifdef USE_GTK
9425 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9426 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9427
9428 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9429 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9430 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9431
9432 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9433 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9434 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9435 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9436 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9437 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9438
9439 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9440 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9441 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9442 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9443 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9444 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9445 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9446 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9447 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9448 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9449 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9450 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9451 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9452 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9453 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9454
9455 x_free_gcs (f);
9456 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9457 }
9458
9459 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9460 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9461 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9462
9463 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9464 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9465 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9466 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9467 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9468 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9469
9470 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9471 {
9472 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9473 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9474 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9475 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9476 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9477 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9478 }
9479
9480 unblock_input ();
9481 }
9482
9483
9484 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9485
9486 static void
9487 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9488 {
9489 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9490
9491 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9492 commands to the X server. */
9493 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9494 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9495
9496 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9497 }
9498
9499 \f
9500 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9501
9502 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9503 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9504 that the window now has.
9505 If USER_POSITION, set the USPosition
9506 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9507 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c. */
9508
9509 #ifndef USE_GTK
9510 void
9511 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, bool user_position)
9512 {
9513 XSizeHints size_hints;
9514 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9515
9516 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9517 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9518 {
9519 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9520 return;
9521 }
9522 #endif
9523
9524 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9525 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9526
9527 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9528 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9529
9530 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9531 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9532
9533 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9534 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9535 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9536 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9537 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9538 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9539
9540 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9541 {
9542 int base_width, base_height;
9543 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9544
9545 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9546 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9547
9548 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9549
9550 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9551 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9552 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9553 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9554 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9555
9556 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9557 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9558 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9559
9560 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9561 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9562 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9563 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9564 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9565 }
9566
9567 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9568 if (flags)
9569 {
9570 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9571 goto no_read;
9572 }
9573
9574 {
9575 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9576 long supplied_return;
9577 int value;
9578
9579 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9580 &supplied_return);
9581
9582 if (flags)
9583 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9584 else
9585 {
9586 if (value == 0)
9587 hints.flags = 0;
9588 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9589 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9590 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9591 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9592 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9593 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9594 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9595 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9596 }
9597 }
9598
9599 no_read:
9600
9601 #ifdef PWinGravity
9602 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9603 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9604
9605 if (user_position)
9606 {
9607 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9608 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9609 }
9610 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9611
9612 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9613 }
9614 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9615
9616 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9617
9618 static void
9619 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9620 {
9621 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9622 Arg al[1];
9623
9624 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9625 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9626 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9627 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9628
9629 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9630 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9631
9632 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9633 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9634 }
9635
9636 static void
9637 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9638 {
9639 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9640
9641 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9642 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9643 #endif
9644
9645 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9646 {
9647 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9648 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9649 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9650 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9651 }
9652 else
9653 {
9654 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9655 pixmap. */
9656 return;
9657 }
9658
9659
9660 #ifdef USE_GTK
9661 {
9662 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9663 return;
9664 }
9665
9666 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9667
9668 {
9669 Arg al[1];
9670 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9671 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9672 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9673 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9674 }
9675
9676 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9677
9678 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9679 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9680
9681 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9682 }
9683
9684 void
9685 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9686 {
9687 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9688
9689 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9690 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9691 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9692
9693 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9694 }
9695
9696 \f
9697 /***********************************************************************
9698 Fonts
9699 ***********************************************************************/
9700
9701 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
9702
9703 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9704 font table. */
9705
9706 static void
9707 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9708 {
9709 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9710 if (font->driver->check)
9711 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9712 }
9713
9714 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
9715
9716 \f
9717 /***********************************************************************
9718 Initialization
9719 ***********************************************************************/
9720
9721 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9722 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9723 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9724 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9725
9726 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9727 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9728 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9729
9730 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9731 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9732 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9733 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9734 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9735 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9736 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9737 };
9738
9739 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9740
9741 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9742
9743 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9744
9745 static int x_initialized;
9746
9747 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9748 the screen number from the server number. */
9749 static int
9750 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9751 {
9752 int seen_colon = 0;
9753 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9754 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9755 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9756
9757 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9758 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9759 length_until_period++;
9760
9761 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9762 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9763 name1 += 4;
9764 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9765 name2 += 4;
9766 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9767 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9768 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9769 name1 += system_name_length;
9770 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9771 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9772 name2 += system_name_length;
9773 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9774 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9775 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9776 name1 += length_until_period;
9777 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9778 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9779 name2 += length_until_period;
9780
9781 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9782 {
9783 if (*name1 == ':')
9784 seen_colon = 1;
9785 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9786 return 1;
9787 }
9788 return (seen_colon
9789 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9790 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9791 }
9792
9793 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9794 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9795 to 5. */
9796 static void
9797 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9798 {
9799 int nr = 0;
9800 int off = 0;
9801
9802 while (!(mask & 1))
9803 {
9804 off++;
9805 mask >>= 1;
9806 }
9807
9808 while (mask & 1)
9809 {
9810 nr++;
9811 mask >>= 1;
9812 }
9813
9814 *offset = off;
9815 *bits = nr;
9816 }
9817
9818 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9819 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9820
9821 int
9822 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9823 {
9824 int dpy_ok = 1;
9825 Display *dpy;
9826
9827 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9828 if (dpy)
9829 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9830 else
9831 dpy_ok = 0;
9832 return dpy_ok;
9833 }
9834
9835 #ifdef USE_GTK
9836 static void
9837 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9838 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9839 {
9840 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9841 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9842 }
9843 #endif
9844
9845 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9846 the structure that describes the open display.
9847 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9848
9849 struct x_display_info *
9850 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9851 {
9852 int connection;
9853 Display *dpy;
9854 struct terminal *terminal;
9855 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9856 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9857 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9858 ptrdiff_t lim;
9859
9860 block_input ();
9861
9862 if (!x_initialized)
9863 {
9864 x_initialize ();
9865 ++x_initialized;
9866 }
9867
9868 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9869 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9870
9871 #ifdef USE_GTK
9872 {
9873 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9874 int argc;
9875 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9876 char **argv2 = argv;
9877 guint id;
9878
9879 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9880 {
9881 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9882 }
9883 else
9884 {
9885 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9886 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9887
9888 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9889 argv[argc] = 0;
9890
9891 argc = 0;
9892 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9893
9894 if (! NILP (display_name))
9895 {
9896 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9897 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9898 }
9899
9900 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9901 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9902
9903 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9904
9905 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9906 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9907 xputenv ("GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1");
9908
9909 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9910 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9911 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9912 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9913
9914 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
9915 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
9916 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9917
9918 /* gtk_init does set_locale. Fix locale before and after. */
9919 fixup_locale ();
9920 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9921 fixup_locale ();
9922
9923 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9924
9925 xg_initialize ();
9926
9927 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9928
9929 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
9930 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9931 {
9932 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9933 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9934
9935 s = build_string (file);
9936 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9937
9938 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9939 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
9940 }
9941 #endif
9942
9943 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9944 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9945 }
9946 }
9947 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9948 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9949 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9950 errors with X11R5:
9951 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9952 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9953 So let's not use it until R6. */
9954 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9955 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9956 #endif
9957
9958 {
9959 int argc = 0;
9960 char *argv[3];
9961
9962 argv[0] = "";
9963 argc = 1;
9964 if (xrm_option)
9965 {
9966 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9967 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9968 }
9969 turn_on_atimers (0);
9970 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
9971 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9972 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9973 &argc, argv);
9974 turn_on_atimers (1);
9975
9976 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9977 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9978 fixup_locale ();
9979 #endif
9980 }
9981
9982 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9983 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9984 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
9985 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9986 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9987
9988 /* Detect failure. */
9989 if (dpy == 0)
9990 {
9991 unblock_input ();
9992 return 0;
9993 }
9994
9995 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9996
9997 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
9998 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9999
10000 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10001
10002 {
10003 struct x_display_info *share;
10004 Lisp_Object tail;
10005
10006 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10007 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10008 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10009 SSDATA (display_name)))
10010 break;
10011 if (share)
10012 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10013 else
10014 {
10015 terminal->kboard = xmalloc (sizeof *terminal->kboard);
10016 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10017 kset_window_system (terminal->kboard, Qx);
10018
10019 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10020 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10021 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10022 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10023 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10024
10025 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10026 {
10027 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10028
10029 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10030 list of terminals. */
10031 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10032 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10033 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10034 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10035
10036 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10037 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10038 unblock_input ();
10039 kset_system_key_alist
10040 (terminal->kboard,
10041 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10042 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string));
10043 block_input ();
10044 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10045 terminal_list = terminal;
10046 UNGCPRO;
10047 }
10048
10049 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10050 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10051 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10052 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10053 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10054 }
10055 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10056 }
10057
10058 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10059 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10060 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10061
10062 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10063 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10064 x_display_name_list);
10065 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10066
10067 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10068
10069 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10070 terminal->name = xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10071 memcpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10072 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10073
10074 #if 0
10075 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10076 #endif /* ! 0 */
10077
10078 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10079 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10080 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10081 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10082 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name) + 2);
10083 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10084 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10085
10086 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10087 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10088
10089 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10090 #ifdef USE_GTK
10091 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10092 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10093 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10094
10095 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10096 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10097
10098 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10099 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10100 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10101 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10102 #else
10103 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10104 #endif
10105 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10106 all versions. */
10107 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10108
10109 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10110 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10111 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10112 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10113 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10114 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10115 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10116 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10117 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10118 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10119 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10120 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10121 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10122 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10123 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10124 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10125 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10126 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10127 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10128 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10129 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10130 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10131 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10132 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10133 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10134 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10135 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10136
10137 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10138 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10139 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10140
10141 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10142 {
10143 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10144 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10145 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10146 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10147 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10148 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10149 }
10150
10151 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10152 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10153 {
10154 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10155 {
10156 Lisp_Object value;
10157 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10158 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10159 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10160 Qnil, Qnil);
10161 if (STRINGP (value)
10162 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10163 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10164 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10165 }
10166 }
10167 else
10168 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10169 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10170
10171 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10172 {
10173 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10174 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10175 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10176 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10177 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10178 for example). */
10179 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10180 double d;
10181 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10182 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10183 }
10184 #endif
10185
10186 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10187 {
10188 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10189 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10190 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10191 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10192 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10193 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10194 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10195 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10196 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10197 }
10198
10199 {
10200 const struct
10201 {
10202 const char *name;
10203 Atom *atom;
10204 } atom_refs[] = {
10205 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10206 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10207 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10208 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10209 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10210 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10211 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10212 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10213 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10214 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10215 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10216 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10217 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10218 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10219 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10220 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10221 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10222 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10223 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10224 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10225 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10226 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10227 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10228 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10229 /* For properties of font. */
10230 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10231 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10232 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10233 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10234 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10235 /* Ghostscript support. */
10236 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10237 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10238 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10239 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10240 /* EWMH */
10241 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10242 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10243 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10244 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10245 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10246 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10247 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10248 { "_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden },
10249 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10250 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10251 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10252 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10253 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10254 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10255 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10256 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10257 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10258 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10259 /* Session management */
10260 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10261 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10262 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10263 };
10264
10265 int i;
10266 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10267 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10268 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10269 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atoms_return);
10270 char **atom_names = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atom_names);
10271 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
10272 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
10273 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
10274
10275 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10276 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10277
10278 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10279 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
10280 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10281 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10282
10283 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10284 False, atoms_return);
10285
10286 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10287 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10288
10289 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10290 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10291
10292 xfree (atom_names);
10293 xfree (atoms_return);
10294 }
10295
10296 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10297 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10298 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
10299 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10300
10301 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10302 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10303 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10304
10305 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10306 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10307 dpyinfo->gray
10308 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10309 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
10310 1, 0, 1);
10311
10312 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10313 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10314 #endif
10315
10316 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10317
10318 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10319 if (connection != 0)
10320 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10321
10322 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10323 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10324 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10325
10326 if (interrupt_input)
10327 init_sigio (connection);
10328
10329 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10330 {
10331 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10332 Font font;
10333
10334 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10335 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10336 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10337 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10338 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10339 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10340 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10341 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10342 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10343 emacs_abort ();
10344 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10345 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10346 x_uncatch_errors ();
10347 }
10348 #endif
10349
10350 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10351 for debugging X code. */
10352 {
10353 Lisp_Object value;
10354 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10355 build_string ("synchronous"),
10356 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10357 Qnil, Qnil);
10358 if (STRINGP (value)
10359 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10360 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10361 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10362 }
10363
10364 {
10365 Lisp_Object value;
10366 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10367 build_string ("useXIM"),
10368 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10369 Qnil, Qnil);
10370 #ifdef USE_XIM
10371 if (STRINGP (value)
10372 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10373 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10374 use_xim = 0;
10375 #else
10376 if (STRINGP (value)
10377 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10378 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10379 use_xim = 1;
10380 #endif
10381 }
10382
10383 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10384 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10385 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10386 tty. */
10387 if (terminal->id == 1)
10388 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10389 #endif
10390
10391 unblock_input ();
10392
10393 return dpyinfo;
10394 }
10395 \f
10396 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10397 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10398
10399 static void
10400 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10401 {
10402 struct terminal *t;
10403
10404 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10405 X display. */
10406 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10407 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10408 {
10409 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10410 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10411 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10412 x_session_close ();
10413 #endif
10414 delete_terminal (t);
10415 break;
10416 }
10417
10418 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10419
10420 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10421 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10422 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10423 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10424 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10425 else
10426 {
10427 Lisp_Object tail;
10428
10429 tail = x_display_name_list;
10430 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10431 {
10432 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10433 {
10434 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10435 break;
10436 }
10437 tail = XCDR (tail);
10438 }
10439 }
10440
10441 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10442 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10443
10444 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10445 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10446 else
10447 {
10448 struct x_display_info *tail;
10449
10450 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10451 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10452 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10453 }
10454
10455 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10456 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10457 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10458 xfree (dpyinfo);
10459 }
10460
10461 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10462
10463 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10464 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10465 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10466 that slows us down. */
10467
10468 static void
10469 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10470 {
10471 block_input ();
10472 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10473 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10474 {
10475 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10476 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10477 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10478 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10479 }
10480 unblock_input ();
10481 }
10482
10483 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10484 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10485 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10486 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10487 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10488 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10489 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10490
10491 void
10492 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10493 {
10494 block_input ();
10495 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10496 {
10497 EMACS_TIME interval = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
10498 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10499 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10500 }
10501 unblock_input ();
10502 }
10503
10504 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10505
10506 \f
10507 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10508
10509 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10510 {
10511 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10512 x_produce_glyphs,
10513 x_write_glyphs,
10514 x_insert_glyphs,
10515 x_clear_end_of_line,
10516 x_scroll_run,
10517 x_after_update_window_line,
10518 x_update_window_begin,
10519 x_update_window_end,
10520 x_cursor_to,
10521 x_flush,
10522 #ifdef XFlush
10523 x_flush,
10524 #else
10525 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10526 #endif
10527 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10528 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10529 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10530 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10531 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10532 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10533 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10534 x_draw_glyph_string,
10535 x_define_frame_cursor,
10536 x_clear_frame_area,
10537 x_draw_window_cursor,
10538 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10539 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10540 };
10541
10542
10543 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10544 void
10545 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10546 {
10547 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10548
10549 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10550 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10551 if (!terminal->name)
10552 return;
10553
10554 block_input ();
10555 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10556 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10557 X display. */
10558 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10559 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10560 #endif
10561
10562 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10563 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10564 if (dpyinfo->display)
10565 {
10566 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10567 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10568
10569 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10570 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10571 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10572 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10573
10574 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10575 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10576 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10577 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10578 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10579 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10580 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10581 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10582 leaks in other situations. */
10583 #if 0
10584 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10585 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10586 #else
10587 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10588 #endif
10589 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10590 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10591 closing all the displays. */
10592 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10593 #endif
10594
10595 #ifdef USE_GTK
10596 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10597 #else
10598 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10599 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10600 #else
10601 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10602 #endif
10603 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10604 }
10605
10606 /* Mark as dead. */
10607 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10608 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10609 unblock_input ();
10610 }
10611
10612 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10613 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10614
10615 static struct terminal *
10616 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10617 {
10618 struct terminal *terminal;
10619
10620 terminal = create_terminal ();
10621
10622 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10623 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10624 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10625
10626 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10627
10628 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10629 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10630 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10631 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10632 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10633 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10634 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10635 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10636 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10637 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10638 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10639 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10640 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10641 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10642 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10643 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10644 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10645 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10646 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10647 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10648
10649 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10650 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10651
10652 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10653 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10654 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10655 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10656 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10657 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10658 off the bottom. */
10659
10660 return terminal;
10661 }
10662
10663 void
10664 x_initialize (void)
10665 {
10666 baud_rate = 19200;
10667
10668 x_noop_count = 0;
10669 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10670 any_help_event_p = 0;
10671 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10672
10673 #ifdef USE_GTK
10674 current_count = -1;
10675 #endif
10676
10677 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10678 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10679
10680 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10681 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10682
10683 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10684
10685 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10686 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10687 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10688 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10689 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10690 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10691 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10692
10693 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10694 #endif
10695
10696 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10697 #ifndef USE_GTK
10698 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10699 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10700 #endif
10701 #endif
10702
10703 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10704 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10705 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10706
10707 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10708 original error handler. */
10709 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10710 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10711 }
10712
10713
10714 void
10715 syms_of_xterm (void)
10716 {
10717 x_error_message = NULL;
10718
10719 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10720 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10721
10722 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10723 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10724
10725 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10726 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10727
10728 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10729 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10730
10731 #ifdef USE_GTK
10732 xg_default_icon_file = build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10733 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10734
10735 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10736 #endif
10737
10738 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10739 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10740 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10741 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10742 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10743 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10744 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10745 sizes. */);
10746 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10747
10748 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10749 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10750 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10751 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10752 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10753 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10754 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10755
10756 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10757 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10758 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10759 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10760 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10761 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10762 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10763 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10764 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10765
10766 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10767 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10768 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10769 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10770 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10771 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10772 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10773 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10774 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10775 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10776 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10777 #elif USE_GTK
10778 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10779 #else
10780 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10781 #endif
10782 #else
10783 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10784 #endif
10785
10786 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10787 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10788
10789 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10790 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10791 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10792 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10793 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10794 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10795 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10796 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10797 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10798
10799 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10800 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10801 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10802 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10803 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10804 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10805
10806 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10807 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10808 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10809 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10810 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10811 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10812
10813 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10814 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10815 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10816 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10817 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10818 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10819
10820 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10821 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10822 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10823 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10824 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10825 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10826
10827 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10828 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10829 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (hashtest_eql, make_number (900),
10830 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10831 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10832 Qnil);
10833 }
10834
10835 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */